874
|
1 *eval.txt* For Vim version 7.0. Last change: 2006 May 06
|
7
|
2
|
|
3
|
|
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
|
5
|
|
6
|
|
7 Expression evaluation *expression* *expr* *E15* *eval*
|
|
8
|
|
9 Using expressions is introduced in chapter 41 of the user manual |usr_41.txt|.
|
|
10
|
|
11 Note: Expression evaluation can be disabled at compile time. If this has been
|
205
|
12 done, the features in this document are not available. See |+eval| and
|
99
|
13 |no-eval-feature|.
|
7
|
14
|
85
|
15 1. Variables |variables|
|
|
16 1.1 Variable types
|
87
|
17 1.2 Function references |Funcref|
|
161
|
18 1.3 Lists |Lists|
|
99
|
19 1.4 Dictionaries |Dictionaries|
|
|
20 1.5 More about variables |more-variables|
|
85
|
21 2. Expression syntax |expression-syntax|
|
|
22 3. Internal variable |internal-variables|
|
|
23 4. Builtin Functions |functions|
|
|
24 5. Defining functions |user-functions|
|
|
25 6. Curly braces names |curly-braces-names|
|
|
26 7. Commands |expression-commands|
|
|
27 8. Exception handling |exception-handling|
|
|
28 9. Examples |eval-examples|
|
|
29 10. No +eval feature |no-eval-feature|
|
|
30 11. The sandbox |eval-sandbox|
|
634
|
31 12. Textlock |textlock|
|
7
|
32
|
|
33 {Vi does not have any of these commands}
|
|
34
|
|
35 ==============================================================================
|
|
36 1. Variables *variables*
|
|
37
|
85
|
38 1.1 Variable types ~
|
114
|
39 *E712*
|
370
|
40 There are five types of variables:
|
55
|
41
|
99
|
42 Number A 32 bit signed number.
|
|
43 Examples: -123 0x10 0177
|
|
44
|
|
45 String A NUL terminated string of 8-bit unsigned characters (bytes).
|
|
46 Examples: "ab\txx\"--" 'x-z''a,c'
|
|
47
|
|
48 Funcref A reference to a function |Funcref|.
|
|
49 Example: function("strlen")
|
|
50
|
|
51 List An ordered sequence of items |List|.
|
|
52 Example: [1, 2, ['a', 'b']]
|
55
|
53
|
370
|
54 Dictionary An associative, unordered array: Each entry has a key and a
|
|
55 value. |Dictionary|
|
|
56 Example: {'blue': "#0000ff", 'red': "#ff0000"}
|
|
57
|
55
|
58 The Number and String types are converted automatically, depending on how they
|
|
59 are used.
|
7
|
60
|
|
61 Conversion from a Number to a String is by making the ASCII representation of
|
|
62 the Number. Examples: >
|
|
63 Number 123 --> String "123"
|
|
64 Number 0 --> String "0"
|
|
65 Number -1 --> String "-1"
|
|
66
|
|
67 Conversion from a String to a Number is done by converting the first digits
|
|
68 to a number. Hexadecimal "0xf9" and Octal "017" numbers are recognized. If
|
|
69 the String doesn't start with digits, the result is zero. Examples: >
|
|
70 String "456" --> Number 456
|
|
71 String "6bar" --> Number 6
|
|
72 String "foo" --> Number 0
|
|
73 String "0xf1" --> Number 241
|
|
74 String "0100" --> Number 64
|
|
75 String "-8" --> Number -8
|
|
76 String "+8" --> Number 0
|
|
77
|
|
78 To force conversion from String to Number, add zero to it: >
|
|
79 :echo "0100" + 0
|
782
|
80 < 64 ~
|
|
81
|
|
82 To avoid a leading zero to cause octal conversion, or for using a different
|
|
83 base, use |str2nr()|.
|
7
|
84
|
|
85 For boolean operators Numbers are used. Zero is FALSE, non-zero is TRUE.
|
|
86
|
|
87 Note that in the command >
|
|
88 :if "foo"
|
|
89 "foo" is converted to 0, which means FALSE. To test for a non-empty string,
|
|
90 use strlen(): >
|
|
91 :if strlen("foo")
|
153
|
92 < *E745* *E728* *E703* *E729* *E730* *E731*
|
|
93 List, Dictionary and Funcref types are not automatically converted.
|
85
|
94
|
|
95 *E706*
|
|
96 You will get an error if you try to change the type of a variable. You need
|
|
97 to |:unlet| it first to avoid this error. String and Number are considered
|
99
|
98 equivalent though. Consider this sequence of commands: >
|
85
|
99 :let l = "string"
|
87
|
100 :let l = 44 " changes type from String to Number
|
85
|
101 :let l = [1, 2, 3] " error!
|
|
102
|
|
103
|
87
|
104 1.2 Function references ~
|
153
|
105 *Funcref* *E695* *E718*
|
55
|
106 A Funcref variable is obtained with the |function()| function. It can be used
|
114
|
107 in an expression in the place of a function name, before the parenthesis
|
|
108 around the arguments, to invoke the function it refers to. Example: >
|
55
|
109
|
|
110 :let Fn = function("MyFunc")
|
|
111 :echo Fn()
|
114
|
112 < *E704* *E705* *E707*
|
819
|
113 A Funcref variable must start with a capital, "s:", "w:", "t:" or "b:". You
|
|
114 cannot have both a Funcref variable and a function with the same name.
|
85
|
115
|
114
|
116 A special case is defining a function and directly assigning its Funcref to a
|
|
117 Dictionary entry. Example: >
|
|
118 :function dict.init() dict
|
|
119 : let self.val = 0
|
|
120 :endfunction
|
|
121
|
|
122 The key of the Dictionary can start with a lower case letter. The actual
|
|
123 function name is not used here. Also see |numbered-function|.
|
|
124
|
|
125 A Funcref can also be used with the |:call| command: >
|
|
126 :call Fn()
|
|
127 :call dict.init()
|
85
|
128
|
|
129 The name of the referenced function can be obtained with |string()|. >
|
119
|
130 :let func = string(Fn)
|
85
|
131
|
|
132 You can use |call()| to invoke a Funcref and use a list variable for the
|
|
133 arguments: >
|
119
|
134 :let r = call(Fn, mylist)
|
85
|
135
|
|
136
|
87
|
137 1.3 Lists ~
|
161
|
138 *List* *Lists* *E686*
|
55
|
139 A List is an ordered sequence of items. An item can be of any type. Items
|
|
140 can be accessed by their index number. Items can be added and removed at any
|
|
141 position in the sequence.
|
|
142
|
85
|
143
|
|
144 List creation ~
|
|
145 *E696* *E697*
|
55
|
146 A List is created with a comma separated list of items in square brackets.
|
85
|
147 Examples: >
|
|
148 :let mylist = [1, two, 3, "four"]
|
|
149 :let emptylist = []
|
55
|
150
|
|
151 An item can be any expression. Using a List for an item creates a
|
842
|
152 List of Lists: >
|
85
|
153 :let nestlist = [[11, 12], [21, 22], [31, 32]]
|
55
|
154
|
|
155 An extra comma after the last item is ignored.
|
|
156
|
85
|
157
|
|
158 List index ~
|
|
159 *list-index* *E684*
|
55
|
160 An item in the List can be accessed by putting the index in square brackets
|
85
|
161 after the List. Indexes are zero-based, thus the first item has index zero. >
|
|
162 :let item = mylist[0] " get the first item: 1
|
55
|
163 :let item = mylist[2] " get the third item: 3
|
85
|
164
|
87
|
165 When the resulting item is a list this can be repeated: >
|
85
|
166 :let item = nestlist[0][1] " get the first list, second item: 12
|
55
|
167 <
|
85
|
168 A negative index is counted from the end. Index -1 refers to the last item in
|
|
169 the List, -2 to the last but one item, etc. >
|
55
|
170 :let last = mylist[-1] " get the last item: "four"
|
|
171
|
85
|
172 To avoid an error for an invalid index use the |get()| function. When an item
|
87
|
173 is not available it returns zero or the default value you specify: >
|
85
|
174 :echo get(mylist, idx)
|
|
175 :echo get(mylist, idx, "NONE")
|
|
176
|
|
177
|
|
178 List concatenation ~
|
|
179
|
|
180 Two lists can be concatenated with the "+" operator: >
|
|
181 :let longlist = mylist + [5, 6]
|
119
|
182 :let mylist += [7, 8]
|
85
|
183
|
|
184 To prepend or append an item turn the item into a list by putting [] around
|
|
185 it. To change a list in-place see |list-modification| below.
|
|
186
|
|
187
|
|
188 Sublist ~
|
|
189
|
55
|
190 A part of the List can be obtained by specifying the first and last index,
|
|
191 separated by a colon in square brackets: >
|
85
|
192 :let shortlist = mylist[2:-1] " get List [3, "four"]
|
55
|
193
|
|
194 Omitting the first index is similar to zero. Omitting the last index is
|
842
|
195 similar to -1.
|
90
|
196 :let endlist = mylist[2:] " from item 2 to the end: [3, "four"]
|
|
197 :let shortlist = mylist[2:2] " List with one item: [3]
|
|
198 :let otherlist = mylist[:] " make a copy of the List
|
85
|
199
|
842
|
200 If the first index is beyond the last item of the List or the second item is
|
|
201 before the first item, the result is an empty list. There is no error
|
|
202 message.
|
|
203
|
|
204 If the second index is equal to or greater than the length of the list the
|
|
205 length minus one is used: >
|
829
|
206 :let mylist = [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
|
207 :echo mylist[2:8] " result: [2, 3]
|
|
208
|
270
|
209 NOTE: mylist[s:e] means using the variable "s:e" as index. Watch out for
|
|
210 using a single letter variable before the ":". Insert a space when needed:
|
|
211 mylist[s : e].
|
|
212
|
85
|
213
|
|
214 List identity ~
|
99
|
215 *list-identity*
|
85
|
216 When variable "aa" is a list and you assign it to another variable "bb", both
|
|
217 variables refer to the same list. Thus changing the list "aa" will also
|
|
218 change "bb": >
|
|
219 :let aa = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
220 :let bb = aa
|
|
221 :call add(aa, 4)
|
|
222 :echo bb
|
114
|
223 < [1, 2, 3, 4]
|
85
|
224
|
|
225 Making a copy of a list is done with the |copy()| function. Using [:] also
|
|
226 works, as explained above. This creates a shallow copy of the list: Changing
|
87
|
227 a list item in the list will also change the item in the copied list: >
|
85
|
228 :let aa = [[1, 'a'], 2, 3]
|
|
229 :let bb = copy(aa)
|
114
|
230 :call add(aa, 4)
|
85
|
231 :let aa[0][1] = 'aaa'
|
|
232 :echo aa
|
114
|
233 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3, 4] >
|
85
|
234 :echo bb
|
114
|
235 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3]
|
85
|
236
|
87
|
237 To make a completely independent list use |deepcopy()|. This also makes a
|
114
|
238 copy of the values in the list, recursively. Up to a hundred levels deep.
|
85
|
239
|
|
240 The operator "is" can be used to check if two variables refer to the same
|
114
|
241 List. "isnot" does the opposite. In contrast "==" compares if two lists have
|
87
|
242 the same value. >
|
|
243 :let alist = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
244 :let blist = [1, 2, 3]
|
|
245 :echo alist is blist
|
114
|
246 < 0 >
|
87
|
247 :echo alist == blist
|
114
|
248 < 1
|
85
|
249
|
323
|
250 Note about comparing lists: Two lists are considered equal if they have the
|
|
251 same length and all items compare equal, as with using "==". There is one
|
388
|
252 exception: When comparing a number with a string they are considered
|
|
253 different. There is no automatic type conversion, as with using "==" on
|
|
254 variables. Example: >
|
|
255 echo 4 == "4"
|
323
|
256 < 1 >
|
388
|
257 echo [4] == ["4"]
|
323
|
258 < 0
|
|
259
|
388
|
260 Thus comparing Lists is more strict than comparing numbers and strings. You
|
|
261 can compare simple values this way too by putting them in a string: >
|
|
262
|
|
263 :let a = 5
|
|
264 :let b = "5"
|
|
265 echo a == b
|
|
266 < 1 >
|
|
267 echo [a] == [b]
|
|
268 < 0
|
323
|
269
|
85
|
270
|
|
271 List unpack ~
|
|
272
|
|
273 To unpack the items in a list to individual variables, put the variables in
|
|
274 square brackets, like list items: >
|
|
275 :let [var1, var2] = mylist
|
|
276
|
|
277 When the number of variables does not match the number of items in the list
|
|
278 this produces an error. To handle any extra items from the list append ";"
|
|
279 and a variable name: >
|
|
280 :let [var1, var2; rest] = mylist
|
|
281
|
|
282 This works like: >
|
|
283 :let var1 = mylist[0]
|
|
284 :let var2 = mylist[1]
|
95
|
285 :let rest = mylist[2:]
|
85
|
286
|
|
287 Except that there is no error if there are only two items. "rest" will be an
|
|
288 empty list then.
|
|
289
|
|
290
|
|
291 List modification ~
|
|
292 *list-modification*
|
87
|
293 To change a specific item of a list use |:let| this way: >
|
85
|
294 :let list[4] = "four"
|
|
295 :let listlist[0][3] = item
|
|
296
|
87
|
297 To change part of a list you can specify the first and last item to be
|
114
|
298 modified. The value must at least have the number of items in the range: >
|
87
|
299 :let list[3:5] = [3, 4, 5]
|
|
300
|
85
|
301 Adding and removing items from a list is done with functions. Here are a few
|
|
302 examples: >
|
|
303 :call insert(list, 'a') " prepend item 'a'
|
|
304 :call insert(list, 'a', 3) " insert item 'a' before list[3]
|
|
305 :call add(list, "new") " append String item
|
114
|
306 :call add(list, [1, 2]) " append a List as one new item
|
85
|
307 :call extend(list, [1, 2]) " extend the list with two more items
|
|
308 :let i = remove(list, 3) " remove item 3
|
108
|
309 :unlet list[3] " idem
|
85
|
310 :let l = remove(list, 3, -1) " remove items 3 to last item
|
108
|
311 :unlet list[3 : ] " idem
|
114
|
312 :call filter(list, 'v:val !~ "x"') " remove items with an 'x'
|
|
313
|
|
314 Changing the order of items in a list: >
|
87
|
315 :call sort(list) " sort a list alphabetically
|
|
316 :call reverse(list) " reverse the order of items
|
|
317
|
85
|
318
|
|
319 For loop ~
|
|
320
|
87
|
321 The |:for| loop executes commands for each item in a list. A variable is set
|
|
322 to each item in the list in sequence. Example: >
|
114
|
323 :for item in mylist
|
|
324 : call Doit(item)
|
85
|
325 :endfor
|
|
326
|
|
327 This works like: >
|
|
328 :let index = 0
|
|
329 :while index < len(mylist)
|
114
|
330 : let item = mylist[index]
|
|
331 : :call Doit(item)
|
85
|
332 : let index = index + 1
|
|
333 :endwhile
|
|
334
|
|
335 Note that all items in the list should be of the same type, otherwise this
|
114
|
336 results in error |E706|. To avoid this |:unlet| the variable at the end of
|
87
|
337 the loop.
|
85
|
338
|
95
|
339 If all you want to do is modify each item in the list then the |map()|
|
114
|
340 function will be a simpler method than a for loop.
|
95
|
341
|
85
|
342 Just like the |:let| command, |:for| also accepts a list of variables. This
|
|
343 requires the argument to be a list of lists. >
|
|
344 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 8], [3, 0]]
|
|
345 : call Doit(lnum, col)
|
|
346 :endfor
|
|
347
|
|
348 This works like a |:let| command is done for each list item. Again, the types
|
|
349 must remain the same to avoid an error.
|
|
350
|
114
|
351 It is also possible to put remaining items in a List variable: >
|
85
|
352 :for [i, j; rest] in listlist
|
|
353 : call Doit(i, j)
|
|
354 : if !empty(rest)
|
|
355 : echo "remainder: " . string(rest)
|
|
356 : endif
|
|
357 :endfor
|
|
358
|
|
359
|
|
360 List functions ~
|
114
|
361 *E714*
|
85
|
362 Functions that are useful with a List: >
|
87
|
363 :let r = call(funcname, list) " call a function with an argument list
|
85
|
364 :if empty(list) " check if list is empty
|
102
|
365 :let l = len(list) " number of items in list
|
|
366 :let big = max(list) " maximum value in list
|
|
367 :let small = min(list) " minimum value in list
|
87
|
368 :let xs = count(list, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in list
|
|
369 :let i = index(list, 'x') " index of first 'x' in list
|
85
|
370 :let lines = getline(1, 10) " get ten text lines from buffer
|
|
371 :call append('$', lines) " append text lines in buffer
|
95
|
372 :let list = split("a b c") " create list from items in a string
|
|
373 :let string = join(list, ', ') " create string from list items
|
102
|
374 :let s = string(list) " String representation of list
|
|
375 :call map(list, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
|
99
|
376
|
258
|
377 Don't forget that a combination of features can make things simple. For
|
|
378 example, to add up all the numbers in a list: >
|
|
379 :exe 'let sum = ' . join(nrlist, '+')
|
|
380
|
99
|
381
|
|
382 1.4 Dictionaries ~
|
114
|
383 *Dictionaries* *Dictionary*
|
99
|
384 A Dictionary is an associative array: Each entry has a key and a value. The
|
114
|
385 entry can be located with the key. The entries are stored without a specific
|
|
386 ordering.
|
99
|
387
|
|
388
|
|
389 Dictionary creation ~
|
114
|
390 *E720* *E721* *E722* *E723*
|
99
|
391 A Dictionary is created with a comma separated list of entries in curly
|
114
|
392 braces. Each entry has a key and a value, separated by a colon. Each key can
|
|
393 only appear once. Examples: >
|
99
|
394 :let mydict = {1: 'one', 2: 'two', 3: 'three'}
|
|
395 :let emptydict = {}
|
114
|
396 < *E713* *E716* *E717*
|
99
|
397 A key is always a String. You can use a Number, it will be converted to a
|
|
398 String automatically. Thus the String '4' and the number 4 will find the same
|
114
|
399 entry. Note that the String '04' and the Number 04 are different, since the
|
|
400 Number will be converted to the String '4'.
|
|
401
|
|
402 A value can be any expression. Using a Dictionary for a value creates a
|
99
|
403 nested Dictionary: >
|
|
404 :let nestdict = {1: {11: 'a', 12: 'b'}, 2: {21: 'c'}}
|
|
405
|
|
406 An extra comma after the last entry is ignored.
|
|
407
|
|
408
|
|
409 Accessing entries ~
|
|
410
|
|
411 The normal way to access an entry is by putting the key in square brackets: >
|
|
412 :let val = mydict["one"]
|
|
413 :let mydict["four"] = 4
|
|
414
|
114
|
415 You can add new entries to an existing Dictionary this way, unlike Lists.
|
99
|
416
|
|
417 For keys that consist entirely of letters, digits and underscore the following
|
|
418 form can be used |expr-entry|: >
|
|
419 :let val = mydict.one
|
|
420 :let mydict.four = 4
|
|
421
|
|
422 Since an entry can be any type, also a List and a Dictionary, the indexing and
|
|
423 key lookup can be repeated: >
|
114
|
424 :echo dict.key[idx].key
|
99
|
425
|
|
426
|
|
427 Dictionary to List conversion ~
|
|
428
|
|
429 You may want to loop over the entries in a dictionary. For this you need to
|
|
430 turn the Dictionary into a List and pass it to |:for|.
|
|
431
|
|
432 Most often you want to loop over the keys, using the |keys()| function: >
|
|
433 :for key in keys(mydict)
|
|
434 : echo key . ': ' . mydict[key]
|
|
435 :endfor
|
|
436
|
|
437 The List of keys is unsorted. You may want to sort them first: >
|
|
438 :for key in sort(keys(mydict))
|
|
439
|
|
440 To loop over the values use the |values()| function: >
|
|
441 :for v in values(mydict)
|
|
442 : echo "value: " . v
|
|
443 :endfor
|
|
444
|
|
445 If you want both the key and the value use the |items()| function. It returns
|
114
|
446 a List in which each item is a List with two items, the key and the value: >
|
99
|
447 :for entry in items(mydict)
|
|
448 : echo entry[0] . ': ' . entry[1]
|
|
449 :endfor
|
|
450
|
|
451
|
|
452 Dictionary identity ~
|
161
|
453 *dict-identity*
|
99
|
454 Just like Lists you need to use |copy()| and |deepcopy()| to make a copy of a
|
|
455 Dictionary. Otherwise, assignment results in referring to the same
|
|
456 Dictionary: >
|
|
457 :let onedict = {'a': 1, 'b': 2}
|
|
458 :let adict = onedict
|
|
459 :let adict['a'] = 11
|
|
460 :echo onedict['a']
|
|
461 11
|
|
462
|
327
|
463 Two Dictionaries compare equal if all the key-value pairs compare equal. For
|
|
464 more info see |list-identity|.
|
99
|
465
|
|
466
|
|
467 Dictionary modification ~
|
|
468 *dict-modification*
|
|
469 To change an already existing entry of a Dictionary, or to add a new entry,
|
|
470 use |:let| this way: >
|
|
471 :let dict[4] = "four"
|
|
472 :let dict['one'] = item
|
|
473
|
108
|
474 Removing an entry from a Dictionary is done with |remove()| or |:unlet|.
|
|
475 Three ways to remove the entry with key "aaa" from dict: >
|
|
476 :let i = remove(dict, 'aaa')
|
|
477 :unlet dict.aaa
|
|
478 :unlet dict['aaa']
|
99
|
479
|
|
480 Merging a Dictionary with another is done with |extend()|: >
|
114
|
481 :call extend(adict, bdict)
|
|
482 This extends adict with all entries from bdict. Duplicate keys cause entries
|
|
483 in adict to be overwritten. An optional third argument can change this.
|
119
|
484 Note that the order of entries in a Dictionary is irrelevant, thus don't
|
|
485 expect ":echo adict" to show the items from bdict after the older entries in
|
|
486 adict.
|
99
|
487
|
|
488 Weeding out entries from a Dictionary can be done with |filter()|: >
|
205
|
489 :call filter(dict 'v:val =~ "x"')
|
114
|
490 This removes all entries from "dict" with a value not matching 'x'.
|
102
|
491
|
|
492
|
|
493 Dictionary function ~
|
114
|
494 *Dictionary-function* *self* *E725*
|
102
|
495 When a function is defined with the "dict" attribute it can be used in a
|
|
496 special way with a dictionary. Example: >
|
|
497 :function Mylen() dict
|
114
|
498 : return len(self.data)
|
102
|
499 :endfunction
|
114
|
500 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3], 'len': function("Mylen")}
|
|
501 :echo mydict.len()
|
102
|
502
|
|
503 This is like a method in object oriented programming. The entry in the
|
|
504 Dictionary is a |Funcref|. The local variable "self" refers to the dictionary
|
|
505 the function was invoked from.
|
|
506
|
114
|
507 It is also possible to add a function without the "dict" attribute as a
|
|
508 Funcref to a Dictionary, but the "self" variable is not available then.
|
|
509
|
819
|
510 *numbered-function* *anonymous-function*
|
102
|
511 To avoid the extra name for the function it can be defined and directly
|
|
512 assigned to a Dictionary in this way: >
|
114
|
513 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3]}
|
|
514 :function mydict.len() dict
|
|
515 : return len(self.data)
|
102
|
516 :endfunction
|
114
|
517 :echo mydict.len()
|
|
518
|
|
519 The function will then get a number and the value of dict.len is a |Funcref|
|
|
520 that references this function. The function can only be used through a
|
|
521 |Funcref|. It will automatically be deleted when there is no |Funcref|
|
|
522 remaining that refers to it.
|
|
523
|
|
524 It is not necessary to use the "dict" attribute for a numbered function.
|
102
|
525
|
|
526
|
|
527 Functions for Dictionaries ~
|
114
|
528 *E715*
|
|
529 Functions that can be used with a Dictionary: >
|
102
|
530 :if has_key(dict, 'foo') " TRUE if dict has entry with key "foo"
|
|
531 :if empty(dict) " TRUE if dict is empty
|
|
532 :let l = len(dict) " number of items in dict
|
|
533 :let big = max(dict) " maximum value in dict
|
|
534 :let small = min(dict) " minimum value in dict
|
|
535 :let xs = count(dict, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in dict
|
|
536 :let s = string(dict) " String representation of dict
|
|
537 :call map(dict, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
|
99
|
538
|
|
539
|
|
540 1.5 More about variables ~
|
85
|
541 *more-variables*
|
7
|
542 If you need to know the type of a variable or expression, use the |type()|
|
|
543 function.
|
|
544
|
|
545 When the '!' flag is included in the 'viminfo' option, global variables that
|
|
546 start with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase letter, are
|
|
547 stored in the viminfo file |viminfo-file|.
|
|
548
|
|
549 When the 'sessionoptions' option contains "global", global variables that
|
|
550 start with an uppercase letter and contain at least one lowercase letter are
|
|
551 stored in the session file |session-file|.
|
|
552
|
|
553 variable name can be stored where ~
|
|
554 my_var_6 not
|
|
555 My_Var_6 session file
|
|
556 MY_VAR_6 viminfo file
|
|
557
|
|
558
|
|
559 It's possible to form a variable name with curly braces, see
|
|
560 |curly-braces-names|.
|
|
561
|
|
562 ==============================================================================
|
|
563 2. Expression syntax *expression-syntax*
|
|
564
|
|
565 Expression syntax summary, from least to most significant:
|
|
566
|
|
567 |expr1| expr2 ? expr1 : expr1 if-then-else
|
|
568
|
|
569 |expr2| expr3 || expr3 .. logical OR
|
|
570
|
|
571 |expr3| expr4 && expr4 .. logical AND
|
|
572
|
|
573 |expr4| expr5 == expr5 equal
|
|
574 expr5 != expr5 not equal
|
|
575 expr5 > expr5 greater than
|
|
576 expr5 >= expr5 greater than or equal
|
|
577 expr5 < expr5 smaller than
|
|
578 expr5 <= expr5 smaller than or equal
|
|
579 expr5 =~ expr5 regexp matches
|
|
580 expr5 !~ expr5 regexp doesn't match
|
|
581
|
|
582 expr5 ==? expr5 equal, ignoring case
|
|
583 expr5 ==# expr5 equal, match case
|
|
584 etc. As above, append ? for ignoring case, # for
|
|
585 matching case
|
|
586
|
685
|
587 expr5 is expr5 same |List| instance
|
|
588 expr5 isnot expr5 different |List| instance
|
79
|
589
|
|
590 |expr5| expr6 + expr6 .. number addition or list concatenation
|
7
|
591 expr6 - expr6 .. number subtraction
|
|
592 expr6 . expr6 .. string concatenation
|
|
593
|
|
594 |expr6| expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication
|
|
595 expr7 / expr7 .. number division
|
|
596 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo
|
|
597
|
|
598 |expr7| ! expr7 logical NOT
|
|
599 - expr7 unary minus
|
|
600 + expr7 unary plus
|
102
|
601
|
|
602
|
685
|
603 |expr8| expr8[expr1] byte of a String or item of a |List|
|
|
604 expr8[expr1 : expr1] substring of a String or sublist of a |List|
|
|
605 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary|
|
|
606 expr8(expr1, ...) function call with |Funcref| variable
|
102
|
607
|
|
608 |expr9| number number constant
|
26
|
609 "string" string constant, backslash is special
|
99
|
610 'string' string constant, ' is doubled
|
685
|
611 [expr1, ...] |List|
|
|
612 {expr1: expr1, ...} |Dictionary|
|
7
|
613 &option option value
|
|
614 (expr1) nested expression
|
|
615 variable internal variable
|
|
616 va{ria}ble internal variable with curly braces
|
|
617 $VAR environment variable
|
|
618 @r contents of register 'r'
|
|
619 function(expr1, ...) function call
|
|
620 func{ti}on(expr1, ...) function call with curly braces
|
|
621
|
|
622
|
|
623 ".." indicates that the operations in this level can be concatenated.
|
|
624 Example: >
|
|
625 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
|
|
626
|
|
627 All expressions within one level are parsed from left to right.
|
|
628
|
|
629
|
|
630 expr1 *expr1* *E109*
|
|
631 -----
|
|
632
|
|
633 expr2 ? expr1 : expr1
|
|
634
|
|
635 The expression before the '?' is evaluated to a number. If it evaluates to
|
|
636 non-zero, the result is the value of the expression between the '?' and ':',
|
|
637 otherwise the result is the value of the expression after the ':'.
|
|
638 Example: >
|
|
639 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum
|
|
640
|
|
641 Since the first expression is an "expr2", it cannot contain another ?:. The
|
|
642 other two expressions can, thus allow for recursive use of ?:.
|
|
643 Example: >
|
|
644 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum == 1000 ? "last" : lnum
|
|
645
|
|
646 To keep this readable, using |line-continuation| is suggested: >
|
|
647 :echo lnum == 1
|
|
648 :\ ? "top"
|
|
649 :\ : lnum == 1000
|
|
650 :\ ? "last"
|
|
651 :\ : lnum
|
|
652
|
|
653
|
|
654 expr2 and expr3 *expr2* *expr3*
|
|
655 ---------------
|
|
656
|
|
657 *expr-barbar* *expr-&&*
|
|
658 The "||" and "&&" operators take one argument on each side. The arguments
|
|
659 are (converted to) Numbers. The result is:
|
|
660
|
|
661 input output ~
|
|
662 n1 n2 n1 || n2 n1 && n2 ~
|
|
663 zero zero zero zero
|
|
664 zero non-zero non-zero zero
|
|
665 non-zero zero non-zero zero
|
|
666 non-zero non-zero non-zero non-zero
|
|
667
|
|
668 The operators can be concatenated, for example: >
|
|
669
|
|
670 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
|
|
671
|
|
672 Note that "&&" takes precedence over "||", so this has the meaning of: >
|
|
673
|
|
674 &nu || (&list && &shell == "csh")
|
|
675
|
|
676 Once the result is known, the expression "short-circuits", that is, further
|
|
677 arguments are not evaluated. This is like what happens in C. For example: >
|
|
678
|
|
679 let a = 1
|
|
680 echo a || b
|
|
681
|
|
682 This is valid even if there is no variable called "b" because "a" is non-zero,
|
|
683 so the result must be non-zero. Similarly below: >
|
|
684
|
|
685 echo exists("b") && b == "yes"
|
|
686
|
|
687 This is valid whether "b" has been defined or not. The second clause will
|
|
688 only be evaluated if "b" has been defined.
|
|
689
|
|
690
|
|
691 expr4 *expr4*
|
|
692 -----
|
|
693
|
|
694 expr5 {cmp} expr5
|
|
695
|
|
696 Compare two expr5 expressions, resulting in a 0 if it evaluates to false, or 1
|
|
697 if it evaluates to true.
|
|
698
|
|
699 *expr-==* *expr-!=* *expr->* *expr->=*
|
|
700 *expr-<* *expr-<=* *expr-=~* *expr-!~*
|
|
701 *expr-==#* *expr-!=#* *expr->#* *expr->=#*
|
|
702 *expr-<#* *expr-<=#* *expr-=~#* *expr-!~#*
|
|
703 *expr-==?* *expr-!=?* *expr->?* *expr->=?*
|
|
704 *expr-<?* *expr-<=?* *expr-=~?* *expr-!~?*
|
79
|
705 *expr-is*
|
7
|
706 use 'ignorecase' match case ignore case ~
|
|
707 equal == ==# ==?
|
|
708 not equal != !=# !=?
|
|
709 greater than > ># >?
|
|
710 greater than or equal >= >=# >=?
|
|
711 smaller than < <# <?
|
|
712 smaller than or equal <= <=# <=?
|
|
713 regexp matches =~ =~# =~?
|
|
714 regexp doesn't match !~ !~# !~?
|
79
|
715 same instance is
|
|
716 different instance isnot
|
7
|
717
|
|
718 Examples:
|
|
719 "abc" ==# "Abc" evaluates to 0
|
|
720 "abc" ==? "Abc" evaluates to 1
|
|
721 "abc" == "Abc" evaluates to 1 if 'ignorecase' is set, 0 otherwise
|
|
722
|
85
|
723 *E691* *E692*
|
685
|
724 A |List| can only be compared with a |List| and only "equal", "not equal" and
|
|
725 "is" can be used. This compares the values of the list, recursively.
|
|
726 Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
|
79
|
727
|
114
|
728 *E735* *E736*
|
685
|
729 A |Dictionary| can only be compared with a |Dictionary| and only "equal", "not
|
|
730 equal" and "is" can be used. This compares the key/values of the |Dictionary|
|
114
|
731 recursively. Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
|
|
732
|
85
|
733 *E693* *E694*
|
685
|
734 A |Funcref| can only be compared with a |Funcref| and only "equal" and "not
|
|
735 equal" can be used. Case is never ignored.
|
|
736
|
|
737 When using "is" or "isnot" with a |List| this checks if the expressions are
|
|
738 referring to the same |List| instance. A copy of a |List| is different from
|
|
739 the original |List|. When using "is" without a |List| it is equivalent to
|
|
740 using "equal", using "isnot" equivalent to using "not equal". Except that a
|
79
|
741 different type means the values are different. "4 == '4'" is true, "4 is '4'"
|
|
742 is false.
|
|
743
|
7
|
744 When comparing a String with a Number, the String is converted to a Number,
|
|
745 and the comparison is done on Numbers. This means that "0 == 'x'" is TRUE,
|
|
746 because 'x' converted to a Number is zero.
|
|
747
|
|
748 When comparing two Strings, this is done with strcmp() or stricmp(). This
|
|
749 results in the mathematical difference (comparing byte values), not
|
|
750 necessarily the alphabetical difference in the local language.
|
|
751
|
|
752 When using the operators with a trailing '#", or the short version and
|
|
753 'ignorecase' is off, the comparing is done with strcmp().
|
|
754
|
|
755 When using the operators with a trailing '?', or the short version and
|
|
756 'ignorecase' is set, the comparing is done with stricmp().
|
|
757
|
|
758 The "=~" and "!~" operators match the lefthand argument with the righthand
|
|
759 argument, which is used as a pattern. See |pattern| for what a pattern is.
|
|
760 This matching is always done like 'magic' was set and 'cpoptions' is empty, no
|
|
761 matter what the actual value of 'magic' or 'cpoptions' is. This makes scripts
|
|
762 portable. To avoid backslashes in the regexp pattern to be doubled, use a
|
|
763 single-quote string, see |literal-string|.
|
|
764 Since a string is considered to be a single line, a multi-line pattern
|
|
765 (containing \n, backslash-n) will not match. However, a literal NL character
|
|
766 can be matched like an ordinary character. Examples:
|
|
767 "foo\nbar" =~ "\n" evaluates to 1
|
|
768 "foo\nbar" =~ "\\n" evaluates to 0
|
|
769
|
|
770
|
|
771 expr5 and expr6 *expr5* *expr6*
|
|
772 ---------------
|
685
|
773 expr6 + expr6 .. Number addition or |List| concatenation *expr-+*
|
79
|
774 expr6 - expr6 .. Number subtraction *expr--*
|
|
775 expr6 . expr6 .. String concatenation *expr-.*
|
|
776
|
692
|
777 For |Lists| only "+" is possible and then both expr6 must be a list. The
|
685
|
778 result is a new list with the two lists Concatenated.
|
79
|
779
|
|
780 expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication *expr-star*
|
|
781 expr7 / expr7 .. number division *expr-/*
|
|
782 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo *expr-%*
|
7
|
783
|
|
784 For all, except ".", Strings are converted to Numbers.
|
|
785
|
|
786 Note the difference between "+" and ".":
|
|
787 "123" + "456" = 579
|
|
788 "123" . "456" = "123456"
|
|
789
|
|
790 When the righthand side of '/' is zero, the result is 0x7fffffff.
|
|
791 When the righthand side of '%' is zero, the result is 0.
|
|
792
|
685
|
793 None of these work for |Funcref|s.
|
79
|
794
|
7
|
795
|
|
796 expr7 *expr7*
|
|
797 -----
|
|
798 ! expr7 logical NOT *expr-!*
|
|
799 - expr7 unary minus *expr-unary--*
|
|
800 + expr7 unary plus *expr-unary-+*
|
|
801
|
|
802 For '!' non-zero becomes zero, zero becomes one.
|
|
803 For '-' the sign of the number is changed.
|
|
804 For '+' the number is unchanged.
|
|
805
|
|
806 A String will be converted to a Number first.
|
|
807
|
|
808 These three can be repeated and mixed. Examples:
|
|
809 !-1 == 0
|
|
810 !!8 == 1
|
|
811 --9 == 9
|
|
812
|
|
813
|
|
814 expr8 *expr8*
|
|
815 -----
|
685
|
816 expr8[expr1] item of String or |List| *expr-[]* *E111*
|
102
|
817
|
|
818 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in a String that contains the
|
|
819 expr1'th single byte from expr8. expr8 is used as a String, expr1 as a
|
55
|
820 Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte encodings.
|
|
821
|
|
822 Index zero gives the first character. This is like it works in C. Careful:
|
|
823 text column numbers start with one! Example, to get the character under the
|
|
824 cursor: >
|
823
|
825 :let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1]
|
7
|
826
|
|
827 If the length of the String is less than the index, the result is an empty
|
55
|
828 String. A negative index always results in an empty string (reason: backwards
|
|
829 compatibility). Use [-1:] to get the last byte.
|
|
830
|
685
|
831 If expr8 is a |List| then it results the item at index expr1. See |list-index|
|
55
|
832 for possible index values. If the index is out of range this results in an
|
|
833 error. Example: >
|
|
834 :let item = mylist[-1] " get last item
|
|
835
|
685
|
836 Generally, if a |List| index is equal to or higher than the length of the
|
|
837 |List|, or more negative than the length of the |List|, this results in an
|
|
838 error.
|
55
|
839
|
99
|
840
|
102
|
841 expr8[expr1a : expr1b] substring or sublist *expr-[:]*
|
|
842
|
|
843 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in the substring with the bytes
|
|
844 from expr1a to and including expr1b. expr8 is used as a String, expr1a and
|
55
|
845 expr1b are used as a Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte
|
|
846 encodings.
|
|
847
|
|
848 If expr1a is omitted zero is used. If expr1b is omitted the length of the
|
|
849 string minus one is used.
|
|
850
|
|
851 A negative number can be used to measure from the end of the string. -1 is
|
|
852 the last character, -2 the last but one, etc.
|
|
853
|
|
854 If an index goes out of range for the string characters are omitted. If
|
|
855 expr1b is smaller than expr1a the result is an empty string.
|
|
856
|
|
857 Examples: >
|
|
858 :let c = name[-1:] " last byte of a string
|
|
859 :let c = name[-2:-2] " last but one byte of a string
|
|
860 :let s = line(".")[4:] " from the fifth byte to the end
|
|
861 :let s = s[:-3] " remove last two bytes
|
|
862
|
685
|
863 If expr8 is a |List| this results in a new |List| with the items indicated by
|
|
864 the indexes expr1a and expr1b. This works like with a String, as explained
|
|
865 just above, except that indexes out of range cause an error. Examples: >
|
55
|
866 :let l = mylist[:3] " first four items
|
|
867 :let l = mylist[4:4] " List with one item
|
|
868 :let l = mylist[:] " shallow copy of a List
|
|
869
|
685
|
870 Using expr8[expr1] or expr8[expr1a : expr1b] on a |Funcref| results in an
|
|
871 error.
|
|
872
|
|
873
|
|
874 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary| *expr-entry*
|
|
875
|
|
876 If expr8 is a |Dictionary| and it is followed by a dot, then the following
|
|
877 name will be used as a key in the |Dictionary|. This is just like:
|
|
878 expr8[name].
|
99
|
879
|
|
880 The name must consist of alphanumeric characters, just like a variable name,
|
|
881 but it may start with a number. Curly braces cannot be used.
|
|
882
|
|
883 There must not be white space before or after the dot.
|
|
884
|
|
885 Examples: >
|
|
886 :let dict = {"one": 1, 2: "two"}
|
|
887 :echo dict.one
|
|
888 :echo dict .2
|
|
889
|
|
890 Note that the dot is also used for String concatenation. To avoid confusion
|
|
891 always put spaces around the dot for String concatenation.
|
|
892
|
|
893
|
685
|
894 expr8(expr1, ...) |Funcref| function call
|
102
|
895
|
|
896 When expr8 is a |Funcref| type variable, invoke the function it refers to.
|
|
897
|
|
898
|
|
899
|
|
900 *expr9*
|
7
|
901 number
|
|
902 ------
|
|
903 number number constant *expr-number*
|
|
904
|
|
905 Decimal, Hexadecimal (starting with 0x or 0X), or Octal (starting with 0).
|
|
906
|
|
907
|
|
908 string *expr-string* *E114*
|
|
909 ------
|
|
910 "string" string constant *expr-quote*
|
|
911
|
|
912 Note that double quotes are used.
|
|
913
|
|
914 A string constant accepts these special characters:
|
|
915 \... three-digit octal number (e.g., "\316")
|
|
916 \.. two-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
|
|
917 \. one-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
|
|
918 \x.. byte specified with two hex numbers (e.g., "\x1f")
|
|
919 \x. byte specified with one hex number (must be followed by non-hex char)
|
|
920 \X.. same as \x..
|
|
921 \X. same as \x.
|
|
922 \u.... character specified with up to 4 hex numbers, stored according to the
|
|
923 current value of 'encoding' (e.g., "\u02a4")
|
|
924 \U.... same as \u....
|
|
925 \b backspace <BS>
|
|
926 \e escape <Esc>
|
|
927 \f formfeed <FF>
|
|
928 \n newline <NL>
|
|
929 \r return <CR>
|
|
930 \t tab <Tab>
|
|
931 \\ backslash
|
|
932 \" double quote
|
|
933 \<xxx> Special key named "xxx". e.g. "\<C-W>" for CTRL-W.
|
|
934
|
|
935 Note that "\000" and "\x00" force the end of the string.
|
|
936
|
|
937
|
|
938 literal-string *literal-string* *E115*
|
|
939 ---------------
|
26
|
940 'string' string constant *expr-'*
|
7
|
941
|
|
942 Note that single quotes are used.
|
|
943
|
26
|
944 This string is taken as it is. No backslashes are removed or have a special
|
99
|
945 meaning. The only exception is that two quotes stand for one quote.
|
26
|
946
|
|
947 Single quoted strings are useful for patterns, so that backslashes do not need
|
|
948 to be doubled. These two commands are equivalent: >
|
|
949 if a =~ "\\s*"
|
|
950 if a =~ '\s*'
|
7
|
951
|
|
952
|
|
953 option *expr-option* *E112* *E113*
|
|
954 ------
|
|
955 &option option value, local value if possible
|
|
956 &g:option global option value
|
|
957 &l:option local option value
|
|
958
|
|
959 Examples: >
|
|
960 echo "tabstop is " . &tabstop
|
|
961 if &insertmode
|
|
962
|
|
963 Any option name can be used here. See |options|. When using the local value
|
|
964 and there is no buffer-local or window-local value, the global value is used
|
|
965 anyway.
|
|
966
|
|
967
|
|
968 register *expr-register*
|
|
969 --------
|
|
970 @r contents of register 'r'
|
|
971
|
|
972 The result is the contents of the named register, as a single string.
|
|
973 Newlines are inserted where required. To get the contents of the unnamed
|
336
|
974 register use @" or @@. See |registers| for an explanation of the available
|
|
975 registers.
|
|
976
|
|
977 When using the '=' register you get the expression itself, not what it
|
|
978 evaluates to. Use |eval()| to evaluate it.
|
7
|
979
|
|
980
|
|
981 nesting *expr-nesting* *E110*
|
|
982 -------
|
|
983 (expr1) nested expression
|
|
984
|
|
985
|
|
986 environment variable *expr-env*
|
|
987 --------------------
|
|
988 $VAR environment variable
|
|
989
|
|
990 The String value of any environment variable. When it is not defined, the
|
|
991 result is an empty string.
|
|
992 *expr-env-expand*
|
|
993 Note that there is a difference between using $VAR directly and using
|
|
994 expand("$VAR"). Using it directly will only expand environment variables that
|
|
995 are known inside the current Vim session. Using expand() will first try using
|
|
996 the environment variables known inside the current Vim session. If that
|
|
997 fails, a shell will be used to expand the variable. This can be slow, but it
|
|
998 does expand all variables that the shell knows about. Example: >
|
|
999 :echo $version
|
|
1000 :echo expand("$version")
|
|
1001 The first one probably doesn't echo anything, the second echoes the $version
|
|
1002 variable (if your shell supports it).
|
|
1003
|
|
1004
|
|
1005 internal variable *expr-variable*
|
|
1006 -----------------
|
|
1007 variable internal variable
|
|
1008 See below |internal-variables|.
|
|
1009
|
|
1010
|
170
|
1011 function call *expr-function* *E116* *E118* *E119* *E120*
|
7
|
1012 -------------
|
|
1013 function(expr1, ...) function call
|
|
1014 See below |functions|.
|
|
1015
|
|
1016
|
|
1017 ==============================================================================
|
|
1018 3. Internal variable *internal-variables* *E121*
|
|
1019 *E461*
|
|
1020 An internal variable name can be made up of letters, digits and '_'. But it
|
|
1021 cannot start with a digit. It's also possible to use curly braces, see
|
|
1022 |curly-braces-names|.
|
|
1023
|
|
1024 An internal variable is created with the ":let" command |:let|.
|
87
|
1025 An internal variable is explicitly destroyed with the ":unlet" command
|
|
1026 |:unlet|.
|
|
1027 Using a name that is not an internal variable or refers to a variable that has
|
|
1028 been destroyed results in an error.
|
7
|
1029
|
|
1030 There are several name spaces for variables. Which one is to be used is
|
|
1031 specified by what is prepended:
|
|
1032
|
|
1033 (nothing) In a function: local to a function; otherwise: global
|
|
1034 |buffer-variable| b: Local to the current buffer.
|
|
1035 |window-variable| w: Local to the current window.
|
819
|
1036 |tabpage-variable| t: Local to the current tab page.
|
7
|
1037 |global-variable| g: Global.
|
|
1038 |local-variable| l: Local to a function.
|
|
1039 |script-variable| s: Local to a |:source|'ed Vim script.
|
|
1040 |function-argument| a: Function argument (only inside a function).
|
|
1041 |vim-variable| v: Global, predefined by Vim.
|
|
1042
|
685
|
1043 The scope name by itself can be used as a |Dictionary|. For example, to
|
|
1044 delete all script-local variables: >
|
133
|
1045 :for k in keys(s:)
|
|
1046 : unlet s:[k]
|
|
1047 :endfor
|
|
1048 <
|
7
|
1049 *buffer-variable* *b:var*
|
|
1050 A variable name that is preceded with "b:" is local to the current buffer.
|
|
1051 Thus you can have several "b:foo" variables, one for each buffer.
|
|
1052 This kind of variable is deleted when the buffer is wiped out or deleted with
|
|
1053 |:bdelete|.
|
|
1054
|
|
1055 One local buffer variable is predefined:
|
|
1056 *b:changedtick-variable* *changetick*
|
|
1057 b:changedtick The total number of changes to the current buffer. It is
|
|
1058 incremented for each change. An undo command is also a change
|
|
1059 in this case. This can be used to perform an action only when
|
|
1060 the buffer has changed. Example: >
|
|
1061 :if my_changedtick != b:changedtick
|
|
1062 : let my_changedtick = b:changedtick
|
|
1063 : call My_Update()
|
|
1064 :endif
|
|
1065 <
|
|
1066 *window-variable* *w:var*
|
|
1067 A variable name that is preceded with "w:" is local to the current window. It
|
|
1068 is deleted when the window is closed.
|
|
1069
|
819
|
1070 *tabpage-variable* *t:var*
|
|
1071 A variable name that is preceded with "t:" is local to the current tab page,
|
|
1072 It is deleted when the tab page is closed. {not available when compiled
|
|
1073 without the +windows feature}
|
|
1074
|
7
|
1075 *global-variable* *g:var*
|
|
1076 Inside functions global variables are accessed with "g:". Omitting this will
|
|
1077 access a variable local to a function. But "g:" can also be used in any other
|
|
1078 place if you like.
|
|
1079
|
|
1080 *local-variable* *l:var*
|
|
1081 Inside functions local variables are accessed without prepending anything.
|
|
1082 But you can also prepend "l:" if you like.
|
|
1083
|
|
1084 *script-variable* *s:var*
|
|
1085 In a Vim script variables starting with "s:" can be used. They cannot be
|
|
1086 accessed from outside of the scripts, thus are local to the script.
|
|
1087
|
|
1088 They can be used in:
|
|
1089 - commands executed while the script is sourced
|
|
1090 - functions defined in the script
|
|
1091 - autocommands defined in the script
|
|
1092 - functions and autocommands defined in functions and autocommands which were
|
|
1093 defined in the script (recursively)
|
|
1094 - user defined commands defined in the script
|
|
1095 Thus not in:
|
|
1096 - other scripts sourced from this one
|
|
1097 - mappings
|
|
1098 - etc.
|
|
1099
|
|
1100 script variables can be used to avoid conflicts with global variable names.
|
|
1101 Take this example:
|
|
1102
|
|
1103 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1104 function MyCounter()
|
|
1105 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1106 echo s:counter
|
|
1107 endfunction
|
|
1108 command Tick call MyCounter()
|
|
1109
|
|
1110 You can now invoke "Tick" from any script, and the "s:counter" variable in
|
|
1111 that script will not be changed, only the "s:counter" in the script where
|
|
1112 "Tick" was defined is used.
|
|
1113
|
|
1114 Another example that does the same: >
|
|
1115
|
|
1116 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1117 command Tick let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | echo s:counter
|
|
1118
|
|
1119 When calling a function and invoking a user-defined command, the context for
|
9
|
1120 script variables is set to the script where the function or command was
|
7
|
1121 defined.
|
|
1122
|
|
1123 The script variables are also available when a function is defined inside a
|
|
1124 function that is defined in a script. Example: >
|
|
1125
|
|
1126 let s:counter = 0
|
|
1127 function StartCounting(incr)
|
|
1128 if a:incr
|
|
1129 function MyCounter()
|
|
1130 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1131 endfunction
|
|
1132 else
|
|
1133 function MyCounter()
|
|
1134 let s:counter = s:counter - 1
|
|
1135 endfunction
|
|
1136 endif
|
|
1137 endfunction
|
|
1138
|
|
1139 This defines the MyCounter() function either for counting up or counting down
|
|
1140 when calling StartCounting(). It doesn't matter from where StartCounting() is
|
|
1141 called, the s:counter variable will be accessible in MyCounter().
|
|
1142
|
|
1143 When the same script is sourced again it will use the same script variables.
|
|
1144 They will remain valid as long as Vim is running. This can be used to
|
|
1145 maintain a counter: >
|
|
1146
|
|
1147 if !exists("s:counter")
|
|
1148 let s:counter = 1
|
|
1149 echo "script executed for the first time"
|
|
1150 else
|
|
1151 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
|
|
1152 echo "script executed " . s:counter . " times now"
|
|
1153 endif
|
|
1154
|
|
1155 Note that this means that filetype plugins don't get a different set of script
|
|
1156 variables for each buffer. Use local buffer variables instead |b:var|.
|
|
1157
|
|
1158
|
|
1159 Predefined Vim variables: *vim-variable* *v:var*
|
|
1160
|
189
|
1161 *v:beval_col* *beval_col-variable*
|
|
1162 v:beval_col The number of the column, over which the mouse pointer is.
|
|
1163 This is the byte index in the |v:beval_lnum| line.
|
|
1164 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1165
|
|
1166 *v:beval_bufnr* *beval_bufnr-variable*
|
|
1167 v:beval_bufnr The number of the buffer, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1168 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1169
|
|
1170 *v:beval_lnum* *beval_lnum-variable*
|
|
1171 v:beval_lnum The number of the line, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1172 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1173
|
|
1174 *v:beval_text* *beval_text-variable*
|
374
|
1175 v:beval_text The text under or after the mouse pointer. Usually a word as
|
|
1176 it is useful for debugging a C program. 'iskeyword' applies,
|
|
1177 but a dot and "->" before the position is included. When on a
|
|
1178 ']' the text before it is used, including the matching '[' and
|
189
|
1179 word before it. When on a Visual area within one line the
|
|
1180 highlighted text is used.
|
|
1181 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1182
|
|
1183 *v:beval_winnr* *beval_winnr-variable*
|
|
1184 v:beval_winnr The number of the window, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
|
|
1185 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
|
|
1186
|
844
|
1187 *v:char* *char-variable*
|
|
1188 v:char Argument for evaluating 'formatexpr'.
|
|
1189
|
7
|
1190 *v:charconvert_from* *charconvert_from-variable*
|
|
1191 v:charconvert_from
|
|
1192 The name of the character encoding of a file to be converted.
|
|
1193 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
|
|
1194
|
|
1195 *v:charconvert_to* *charconvert_to-variable*
|
|
1196 v:charconvert_to
|
|
1197 The name of the character encoding of a file after conversion.
|
|
1198 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
|
|
1199
|
|
1200 *v:cmdarg* *cmdarg-variable*
|
|
1201 v:cmdarg This variable is used for two purposes:
|
|
1202 1. The extra arguments given to a file read/write command.
|
|
1203 Currently these are "++enc=" and "++ff=". This variable is
|
|
1204 set before an autocommand event for a file read/write
|
|
1205 command is triggered. There is a leading space to make it
|
|
1206 possible to append this variable directly after the
|
|
1207 read/write command. Note: The "+cmd" argument isn't
|
|
1208 included here, because it will be executed anyway.
|
|
1209 2. When printing a PostScript file with ":hardcopy" this is
|
|
1210 the argument for the ":hardcopy" command. This can be used
|
|
1211 in 'printexpr'.
|
|
1212
|
|
1213 *v:cmdbang* *cmdbang-variable*
|
|
1214 v:cmdbang Set like v:cmdarg for a file read/write command. When a "!"
|
|
1215 was used the value is 1, otherwise it is 0. Note that this
|
|
1216 can only be used in autocommands. For user commands |<bang>|
|
|
1217 can be used.
|
|
1218
|
|
1219 *v:count* *count-variable*
|
|
1220 v:count The count given for the last Normal mode command. Can be used
|
|
1221 to get the count before a mapping. Read-only. Example: >
|
|
1222 :map _x :<C-U>echo "the count is " . v:count<CR>
|
|
1223 < Note: The <C-U> is required to remove the line range that you
|
|
1224 get when typing ':' after a count.
|
667
|
1225 Also used for evaluating the 'formatexpr' option.
|
7
|
1226 "count" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1227
|
|
1228 *v:count1* *count1-variable*
|
|
1229 v:count1 Just like "v:count", but defaults to one when no count is
|
|
1230 used.
|
|
1231
|
|
1232 *v:ctype* *ctype-variable*
|
|
1233 v:ctype The current locale setting for characters of the runtime
|
|
1234 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1235 current locale encoding. Technical: it's the value of
|
|
1236 LC_CTYPE. When not using a locale the value is "C".
|
|
1237 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1238 command.
|
|
1239 See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1240
|
|
1241 *v:dying* *dying-variable*
|
|
1242 v:dying Normally zero. When a deadly signal is caught it's set to
|
|
1243 one. When multiple signals are caught the number increases.
|
|
1244 Can be used in an autocommand to check if Vim didn't
|
|
1245 terminate normally. {only works on Unix}
|
|
1246 Example: >
|
|
1247 :au VimLeave * if v:dying | echo "\nAAAAaaaarrrggghhhh!!!\n" | endif
|
|
1248 <
|
|
1249 *v:errmsg* *errmsg-variable*
|
|
1250 v:errmsg Last given error message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1251 Example: >
|
|
1252 :let v:errmsg = ""
|
|
1253 :silent! next
|
|
1254 :if v:errmsg != ""
|
|
1255 : ... handle error
|
|
1256 < "errmsg" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1257
|
|
1258 *v:exception* *exception-variable*
|
|
1259 v:exception The value of the exception most recently caught and not
|
|
1260 finished. See also |v:throwpoint| and |throw-variables|.
|
|
1261 Example: >
|
|
1262 :try
|
|
1263 : throw "oops"
|
|
1264 :catch /.*/
|
|
1265 : echo "caught" v:exception
|
|
1266 :endtry
|
|
1267 < Output: "caught oops".
|
|
1268
|
179
|
1269 *v:fcs_reason* *fcs_reason-variable*
|
|
1270 v:fcs_reason The reason why the |FileChangedShell| event was triggered.
|
|
1271 Can be used in an autocommand to decide what to do and/or what
|
|
1272 to set v:fcs_choice to. Possible values:
|
|
1273 deleted file no longer exists
|
|
1274 conflict file contents, mode or timestamp was
|
|
1275 changed and buffer is modified
|
|
1276 changed file contents has changed
|
|
1277 mode mode of file changed
|
|
1278 time only file timestamp changed
|
|
1279
|
|
1280 *v:fcs_choice* *fcs_choice-variable*
|
|
1281 v:fcs_choice What should happen after a |FileChangedShell| event was
|
|
1282 triggered. Can be used in an autocommand to tell Vim what to
|
|
1283 do with the affected buffer:
|
|
1284 reload Reload the buffer (does not work if
|
|
1285 the file was deleted).
|
|
1286 ask Ask the user what to do, as if there
|
|
1287 was no autocommand. Except that when
|
|
1288 only the timestamp changed nothing
|
|
1289 will happen.
|
|
1290 <empty> Nothing, the autocommand should do
|
|
1291 everything that needs to be done.
|
|
1292 The default is empty. If another (invalid) value is used then
|
|
1293 Vim behaves like it is empty, there is no warning message.
|
|
1294
|
7
|
1295 *v:fname_in* *fname_in-variable*
|
579
|
1296 v:fname_in The name of the input file. Valid while evaluating:
|
7
|
1297 option used for ~
|
|
1298 'charconvert' file to be converted
|
|
1299 'diffexpr' original file
|
|
1300 'patchexpr' original file
|
|
1301 'printexpr' file to be printed
|
593
|
1302 And set to the swap file name for |SwapExists|.
|
7
|
1303
|
|
1304 *v:fname_out* *fname_out-variable*
|
|
1305 v:fname_out The name of the output file. Only valid while
|
|
1306 evaluating:
|
|
1307 option used for ~
|
|
1308 'charconvert' resulting converted file (*)
|
|
1309 'diffexpr' output of diff
|
|
1310 'patchexpr' resulting patched file
|
|
1311 (*) When doing conversion for a write command (e.g., ":w
|
|
1312 file") it will be equal to v:fname_in. When doing conversion
|
|
1313 for a read command (e.g., ":e file") it will be a temporary
|
|
1314 file and different from v:fname_in.
|
|
1315
|
|
1316 *v:fname_new* *fname_new-variable*
|
|
1317 v:fname_new The name of the new version of the file. Only valid while
|
|
1318 evaluating 'diffexpr'.
|
|
1319
|
|
1320 *v:fname_diff* *fname_diff-variable*
|
|
1321 v:fname_diff The name of the diff (patch) file. Only valid while
|
|
1322 evaluating 'patchexpr'.
|
|
1323
|
|
1324 *v:folddashes* *folddashes-variable*
|
|
1325 v:folddashes Used for 'foldtext': dashes representing foldlevel of a closed
|
|
1326 fold.
|
29
|
1327 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1328
|
|
1329 *v:foldlevel* *foldlevel-variable*
|
|
1330 v:foldlevel Used for 'foldtext': foldlevel of closed fold.
|
29
|
1331 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1332
|
|
1333 *v:foldend* *foldend-variable*
|
|
1334 v:foldend Used for 'foldtext': last line of closed fold.
|
29
|
1335 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1336
|
|
1337 *v:foldstart* *foldstart-variable*
|
|
1338 v:foldstart Used for 'foldtext': first line of closed fold.
|
29
|
1339 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
|
7
|
1340
|
11
|
1341 *v:insertmode* *insertmode-variable*
|
|
1342 v:insertmode Used for the |InsertEnter| and |InsertChange| autocommand
|
|
1343 events. Values:
|
|
1344 i Insert mode
|
|
1345 r Replace mode
|
|
1346 v Virtual Replace mode
|
|
1347
|
102
|
1348 *v:key* *key-variable*
|
685
|
1349 v:key Key of the current item of a |Dictionary|. Only valid while
|
102
|
1350 evaluating the expression used with |map()| and |filter()|.
|
|
1351 Read-only.
|
|
1352
|
7
|
1353 *v:lang* *lang-variable*
|
|
1354 v:lang The current locale setting for messages of the runtime
|
|
1355 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1356 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_MESSAGES.
|
|
1357 The value is system dependent.
|
|
1358 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1359 command.
|
|
1360 It can be different from |v:ctype| when messages are desired
|
|
1361 in a different language than what is used for character
|
|
1362 encoding. See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1363
|
|
1364 *v:lc_time* *lc_time-variable*
|
|
1365 v:lc_time The current locale setting for time messages of the runtime
|
|
1366 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
|
|
1367 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_TIME.
|
|
1368 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
|
|
1369 command. See |multi-lang|.
|
|
1370
|
|
1371 *v:lnum* *lnum-variable*
|
29
|
1372 v:lnum Line number for the 'foldexpr' |fold-expr| and 'indentexpr'
|
839
|
1373 expressions, tab page number for 'guitablabel' and
|
|
1374 'guitabtooltip'. Only valid while one of these expressions is
|
|
1375 being evaluated. Read-only when in the |sandbox|.
|
7
|
1376
|
|
1377 *v:prevcount* *prevcount-variable*
|
|
1378 v:prevcount The count given for the last but one Normal mode command.
|
|
1379 This is the v:count value of the previous command. Useful if
|
|
1380 you want to cancel Visual mode and then use the count. >
|
|
1381 :vmap % <Esc>:call MyFilter(v:prevcount)<CR>
|
|
1382 < Read-only.
|
|
1383
|
170
|
1384 *v:profiling* *profiling-variable*
|
|
1385 v:profiling Normally zero. Set to one after using ":profile start".
|
|
1386 See |profiling|.
|
|
1387
|
7
|
1388 *v:progname* *progname-variable*
|
|
1389 v:progname Contains the name (with path removed) with which Vim was
|
|
1390 invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for "view",
|
|
1391 "evim" etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim.
|
|
1392 Read-only.
|
|
1393
|
|
1394 *v:register* *register-variable*
|
|
1395 v:register The name of the register supplied to the last normal mode
|
|
1396 command. Empty if none were supplied. |getreg()| |setreg()|
|
|
1397
|
540
|
1398 *v:scrollstart* *scrollstart-variable*
|
|
1399 v:scrollstart String describing the script or function that caused the
|
|
1400 screen to scroll up. It's only set when it is empty, thus the
|
|
1401 first reason is remembered. It is set to "Unknown" for a
|
|
1402 typed command.
|
|
1403 This can be used to find out why your script causes the
|
|
1404 hit-enter prompt.
|
|
1405
|
7
|
1406 *v:servername* *servername-variable*
|
|
1407 v:servername The resulting registered |x11-clientserver| name if any.
|
|
1408 Read-only.
|
|
1409
|
|
1410 *v:shell_error* *shell_error-variable*
|
|
1411 v:shell_error Result of the last shell command. When non-zero, the last
|
|
1412 shell command had an error. When zero, there was no problem.
|
|
1413 This only works when the shell returns the error code to Vim.
|
|
1414 The value -1 is often used when the command could not be
|
|
1415 executed. Read-only.
|
|
1416 Example: >
|
|
1417 :!mv foo bar
|
|
1418 :if v:shell_error
|
|
1419 : echo 'could not rename "foo" to "bar"!'
|
|
1420 :endif
|
|
1421 < "shell_error" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1422
|
|
1423 *v:statusmsg* *statusmsg-variable*
|
|
1424 v:statusmsg Last given status message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1425
|
579
|
1426 *v:swapname* *swapname-variable*
|
|
1427 v:swapname Only valid when executing |SwapExists| autocommands: Name of
|
|
1428 the swap file found. Read-only.
|
|
1429
|
|
1430 *v:swapchoice* *swapchoice-variable*
|
|
1431 v:swapchoice |SwapExists| autocommands can set this to the selected choice
|
|
1432 for handling an existing swap file:
|
|
1433 'o' Open read-only
|
|
1434 'e' Edit anyway
|
|
1435 'r' Recover
|
|
1436 'd' Delete swapfile
|
|
1437 'q' Quit
|
|
1438 'a' Abort
|
|
1439 The value should be a single-character string. An empty value
|
|
1440 results in the user being asked, as would happen when there is
|
|
1441 no SwapExists autocommand. The default is empty.
|
|
1442
|
590
|
1443 *v:swapcommand* *swapcommand-variable*
|
625
|
1444 v:swapcommand Normal mode command to be executed after a file has been
|
590
|
1445 opened. Can be used for a |SwapExists| autocommand to have
|
|
1446 another Vim open the file and jump to the right place. For
|
|
1447 example, when jumping to a tag the value is ":tag tagname\r".
|
716
|
1448 For ":edit +cmd file" the value is ":cmd\r".
|
590
|
1449
|
7
|
1450 *v:termresponse* *termresponse-variable*
|
|
1451 v:termresponse The escape sequence returned by the terminal for the |t_RV|
|
|
1452 termcap entry. It is set when Vim receives an escape sequence
|
|
1453 that starts with ESC [ or CSI and ends in a 'c', with only
|
|
1454 digits, ';' and '.' in between.
|
|
1455 When this option is set, the TermResponse autocommand event is
|
|
1456 fired, so that you can react to the response from the
|
|
1457 terminal.
|
|
1458 The response from a new xterm is: "<Esc>[ Pp ; Pv ; Pc c". Pp
|
|
1459 is the terminal type: 0 for vt100 and 1 for vt220. Pv is the
|
|
1460 patch level (since this was introduced in patch 95, it's
|
|
1461 always 95 or bigger). Pc is always zero.
|
|
1462 {only when compiled with |+termresponse| feature}
|
|
1463
|
|
1464 *v:this_session* *this_session-variable*
|
|
1465 v:this_session Full filename of the last loaded or saved session file. See
|
|
1466 |:mksession|. It is allowed to set this variable. When no
|
|
1467 session file has been saved, this variable is empty.
|
|
1468 "this_session" also works, for backwards compatibility.
|
|
1469
|
|
1470 *v:throwpoint* *throwpoint-variable*
|
|
1471 v:throwpoint The point where the exception most recently caught and not
|
|
1472 finished was thrown. Not set when commands are typed. See
|
|
1473 also |v:exception| and |throw-variables|.
|
|
1474 Example: >
|
|
1475 :try
|
|
1476 : throw "oops"
|
|
1477 :catch /.*/
|
|
1478 : echo "Exception from" v:throwpoint
|
|
1479 :endtry
|
|
1480 < Output: "Exception from test.vim, line 2"
|
|
1481
|
102
|
1482 *v:val* *val-variable*
|
685
|
1483 v:val Value of the current item of a |List| or |Dictionary|. Only
|
|
1484 valid while evaluating the expression used with |map()| and
|
102
|
1485 |filter()|. Read-only.
|
|
1486
|
7
|
1487 *v:version* *version-variable*
|
|
1488 v:version Version number of Vim: Major version number times 100 plus
|
|
1489 minor version number. Version 5.0 is 500. Version 5.1 (5.01)
|
|
1490 is 501. Read-only. "version" also works, for backwards
|
|
1491 compatibility.
|
|
1492 Use |has()| to check if a certain patch was included, e.g.: >
|
|
1493 if has("patch123")
|
|
1494 < Note that patch numbers are specific to the version, thus both
|
|
1495 version 5.0 and 5.1 may have a patch 123, but these are
|
|
1496 completely different.
|
|
1497
|
|
1498 *v:warningmsg* *warningmsg-variable*
|
|
1499 v:warningmsg Last given warning message. It's allowed to set this variable.
|
|
1500
|
|
1501 ==============================================================================
|
|
1502 4. Builtin Functions *functions*
|
|
1503
|
|
1504 See |function-list| for a list grouped by what the function is used for.
|
|
1505
|
236
|
1506 (Use CTRL-] on the function name to jump to the full explanation.)
|
7
|
1507
|
|
1508 USAGE RESULT DESCRIPTION ~
|
|
1509
|
685
|
1510 add( {list}, {item}) List append {item} to |List| {list}
|
55
|
1511 append( {lnum}, {string}) Number append {string} below line {lnum}
|
161
|
1512 append( {lnum}, {list}) Number append lines {list} below line {lnum}
|
7
|
1513 argc() Number number of files in the argument list
|
55
|
1514 argidx() Number current index in the argument list
|
7
|
1515 argv( {nr}) String {nr} entry of the argument list
|
818
|
1516 argv( ) List the argument list
|
7
|
1517 browse( {save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
|
|
1518 String put up a file requester
|
29
|
1519 browsedir( {title}, {initdir}) String put up a directory requester
|
7
|
1520 bufexists( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} exists
|
55
|
1521 buflisted( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is listed
|
|
1522 bufloaded( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is loaded
|
7
|
1523 bufname( {expr}) String Name of the buffer {expr}
|
|
1524 bufnr( {expr}) Number Number of the buffer {expr}
|
|
1525 bufwinnr( {expr}) Number window number of buffer {expr}
|
|
1526 byte2line( {byte}) Number line number at byte count {byte}
|
55
|
1527 byteidx( {expr}, {nr}) Number byte index of {nr}'th char in {expr}
|
102
|
1528 call( {func}, {arglist} [, {dict}])
|
|
1529 any call {func} with arguments {arglist}
|
777
|
1530 changenr() Number current change number
|
7
|
1531 char2nr( {expr}) Number ASCII value of first char in {expr}
|
55
|
1532 cindent( {lnum}) Number C indent for line {lnum}
|
7
|
1533 col( {expr}) Number column nr of cursor or mark
|
724
|
1534 complete({startcol}, {matches}) String set Insert mode completion
|
464
|
1535 complete_add( {expr}) Number add completion match
|
|
1536 complete_check() Number check for key typed during completion
|
7
|
1537 confirm( {msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
|
|
1538 Number number of choice picked by user
|
55
|
1539 copy( {expr}) any make a shallow copy of {expr}
|
95
|
1540 count( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
|
|
1541 Number count how many {expr} are in {list}
|
7
|
1542 cscope_connection( [{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
|
|
1543 Number checks existence of cscope connection
|
703
|
1544 cursor( {lnum}, {col} [, {coladd}])
|
|
1545 Number move cursor to {lnum}, {col}, {coladd}
|
|
1546 cursor( {list}) Number move cursor to position in {list}
|
55
|
1547 deepcopy( {expr}) any make a full copy of {expr}
|
7
|
1548 delete( {fname}) Number delete file {fname}
|
|
1549 did_filetype() Number TRUE if FileType autocommand event used
|
55
|
1550 diff_filler( {lnum}) Number diff filler lines about {lnum}
|
|
1551 diff_hlID( {lnum}, {col}) Number diff highlighting at {lnum}/{col}
|
85
|
1552 empty( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is empty
|
7
|
1553 escape( {string}, {chars}) String escape {chars} in {string} with '\'
|
205
|
1554 eval( {string}) any evaluate {string} into its value
|
55
|
1555 eventhandler( ) Number TRUE if inside an event handler
|
7
|
1556 executable( {expr}) Number 1 if executable {expr} exists
|
|
1557 exists( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} exists
|
824
|
1558 extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}])
|
|
1559 List/Dict insert items of {expr2} into {expr1}
|
7
|
1560 expand( {expr}) String expand special keywords in {expr}
|
842
|
1561 feedkeys( {string} [, {mode}]) Number add key sequence to typeahead buffer
|
7
|
1562 filereadable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a readable file
|
824
|
1563 filewritable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a writable file
|
102
|
1564 filter( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict remove items from {expr} where
|
|
1565 {string} is 0
|
95
|
1566 finddir( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
|
824
|
1567 String find directory {name} in {path}
|
19
|
1568 findfile( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
|
824
|
1569 String find file {name} in {path}
|
7
|
1570 fnamemodify( {fname}, {mods}) String modify file name
|
55
|
1571 foldclosed( {lnum}) Number first line of fold at {lnum} if closed
|
|
1572 foldclosedend( {lnum}) Number last line of fold at {lnum} if closed
|
7
|
1573 foldlevel( {lnum}) Number fold level at {lnum}
|
55
|
1574 foldtext( ) String line displayed for closed fold
|
824
|
1575 foldtextresult( {lnum}) String text for closed fold at {lnum}
|
7
|
1576 foreground( ) Number bring the Vim window to the foreground
|
55
|
1577 function( {name}) Funcref reference to function {name}
|
824
|
1578 garbagecollect() none free memory, breaking cyclic references
|
82
|
1579 get( {list}, {idx} [, {def}]) any get item {idx} from {list} or {def}
|
102
|
1580 get( {dict}, {key} [, {def}]) any get item {key} from {dict} or {def}
|
435
|
1581 getbufline( {expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
|
|
1582 List lines {lnum} to {end} of buffer {expr}
|
824
|
1583 getbufvar( {expr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in buffer {expr}
|
55
|
1584 getchar( [expr]) Number get one character from the user
|
|
1585 getcharmod( ) Number modifiers for the last typed character
|
7
|
1586 getcmdline() String return the current command-line
|
|
1587 getcmdpos() Number return cursor position in command-line
|
531
|
1588 getcmdtype() String return the current command-line type
|
7
|
1589 getcwd() String the current working directory
|
20
|
1590 getfperm( {fname}) String file permissions of file {fname}
|
|
1591 getfsize( {fname}) Number size in bytes of file {fname}
|
37
|
1592 getfontname( [{name}]) String name of font being used
|
7
|
1593 getftime( {fname}) Number last modification time of file
|
20
|
1594 getftype( {fname}) String description of type of file {fname}
|
161
|
1595 getline( {lnum}) String line {lnum} of current buffer
|
|
1596 getline( {lnum}, {end}) List lines {lnum} to {end} of current buffer
|
647
|
1597 getloclist({nr}) List list of location list items
|
703
|
1598 getpos( {expr}) List position of cursor, mark, etc.
|
230
|
1599 getqflist() List list of quickfix items
|
282
|
1600 getreg( [{regname} [, 1]]) String contents of register
|
55
|
1601 getregtype( [{regname}]) String type of register
|
831
|
1602 gettabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {name})
|
|
1603 any {name} in {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}
|
7
|
1604 getwinposx() Number X coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
|
|
1605 getwinposy() Number Y coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
|
824
|
1606 getwinvar( {nr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in window {nr}
|
7
|
1607 glob( {expr}) String expand file wildcards in {expr}
|
|
1608 globpath( {path}, {expr}) String do glob({expr}) for all dirs in {path}
|
|
1609 has( {feature}) Number TRUE if feature {feature} supported
|
102
|
1610 has_key( {dict}, {key}) Number TRUE if {dict} has entry {key}
|
782
|
1611 hasmapto( {what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1612 Number TRUE if mapping to {what} exists
|
7
|
1613 histadd( {history},{item}) String add an item to a history
|
|
1614 histdel( {history} [, {item}]) String remove an item from a history
|
|
1615 histget( {history} [, {index}]) String get the item {index} from a history
|
|
1616 histnr( {history}) Number highest index of a history
|
|
1617 hlexists( {name}) Number TRUE if highlight group {name} exists
|
|
1618 hlID( {name}) Number syntax ID of highlight group {name}
|
|
1619 hostname() String name of the machine Vim is running on
|
55
|
1620 iconv( {expr}, {from}, {to}) String convert encoding of {expr}
|
|
1621 indent( {lnum}) Number indent of line {lnum}
|
95
|
1622 index( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
|
|
1623 Number index in {list} where {expr} appears
|
531
|
1624 input( {prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]])
|
|
1625 String get input from the user
|
7
|
1626 inputdialog( {p} [, {t} [, {c}]]) String like input() but in a GUI dialog
|
824
|
1627 inputlist( {textlist}) Number let the user pick from a choice list
|
55
|
1628 inputrestore() Number restore typeahead
|
|
1629 inputsave() Number save and clear typeahead
|
7
|
1630 inputsecret( {prompt} [, {text}]) String like input() but hiding the text
|
55
|
1631 insert( {list}, {item} [, {idx}]) List insert {item} in {list} [before {idx}]
|
7
|
1632 isdirectory( {directory}) Number TRUE if {directory} is a directory
|
148
|
1633 islocked( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is locked
|
685
|
1634 items( {dict}) List key-value pairs in {dict}
|
95
|
1635 join( {list} [, {sep}]) String join {list} items into one String
|
685
|
1636 keys( {dict}) List keys in {dict}
|
55
|
1637 len( {expr}) Number the length of {expr}
|
|
1638 libcall( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) String call {func} in library {lib} with {arg}
|
7
|
1639 libcallnr( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) Number idem, but return a Number
|
|
1640 line( {expr}) Number line nr of cursor, last line or mark
|
|
1641 line2byte( {lnum}) Number byte count of line {lnum}
|
55
|
1642 lispindent( {lnum}) Number Lisp indent for line {lnum}
|
7
|
1643 localtime() Number current time
|
102
|
1644 map( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict change each item in {expr} to {expr}
|
782
|
1645 maparg( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1646 String rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}
|
|
1647 mapcheck( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
|
|
1648 String check for mappings matching {name}
|
19
|
1649 match( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
7
|
1650 Number position where {pat} matches in {expr}
|
819
|
1651 matcharg( {nr}) List arguments of |:match|
|
19
|
1652 matchend( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
7
|
1653 Number position where {pat} ends in {expr}
|
158
|
1654 matchlist( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
|
1655 List match and submatches of {pat} in {expr}
|
19
|
1656 matchstr( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
|
|
1657 String {count}'th match of {pat} in {expr}
|
87
|
1658 max({list}) Number maximum value of items in {list}
|
|
1659 min({list}) Number minumum value of items in {list}
|
168
|
1660 mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
|
|
1661 Number create directory {name}
|
55
|
1662 mode() String current editing mode
|
7
|
1663 nextnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line >= {lnum}
|
|
1664 nr2char( {expr}) String single char with ASCII value {expr}
|
819
|
1665 pathshorten( {expr}) String shorten directory names in a path
|
7
|
1666 prevnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line <= {lnum}
|
449
|
1667 printf( {fmt}, {expr1}...) String format text
|
667
|
1668 pumvisible() Number whether popup menu is visible
|
99
|
1669 range( {expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]])
|
|
1670 List items from {expr} to {max}
|
168
|
1671 readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
|
|
1672 List get list of lines from file {fname}
|
794
|
1673 reltime( [{start} [, {end}]]) List get time value
|
|
1674 reltimestr( {time}) String turn time value into a String
|
7
|
1675 remote_expr( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
1676 String send expression
|
|
1677 remote_foreground( {server}) Number bring Vim server to the foreground
|
|
1678 remote_peek( {serverid} [, {retvar}])
|
|
1679 Number check for reply string
|
|
1680 remote_read( {serverid}) String read reply string
|
|
1681 remote_send( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
1682 String send key sequence
|
79
|
1683 remove( {list}, {idx} [, {end}]) any remove items {idx}-{end} from {list}
|
856
|
1684 remove( {dict}, {key}) any remove entry {key} from {dict}
|
55
|
1685 rename( {from}, {to}) Number rename (move) file from {from} to {to}
|
|
1686 repeat( {expr}, {count}) String repeat {expr} {count} times
|
|
1687 resolve( {filename}) String get filename a shortcut points to
|
82
|
1688 reverse( {list}) List reverse {list} in-place
|
55
|
1689 search( {pattern} [, {flags}]) Number search for {pattern}
|
523
|
1690 searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]])
|
|
1691 Number search for variable declaration
|
692
|
1692 searchpair( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
55
|
1693 Number search for other end of start/end pair
|
692
|
1694 searchpairpos( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
667
|
1695 List search for other end of start/end pair
|
692
|
1696 searchpos( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]])
|
667
|
1697 List search for {pattern}
|
7
|
1698 server2client( {clientid}, {string})
|
|
1699 Number send reply string
|
|
1700 serverlist() String get a list of available servers
|
|
1701 setbufvar( {expr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in buffer {expr} to {val}
|
|
1702 setcmdpos( {pos}) Number set cursor position in command-line
|
|
1703 setline( {lnum}, {line}) Number set line {lnum} to {line}
|
647
|
1704 setloclist( {nr}, {list}[, {action}])
|
|
1705 Number modify location list using {list}
|
824
|
1706 setpos( {expr}, {list}) none set the {expr} position to {list}
|
647
|
1707 setqflist( {list}[, {action}]) Number modify quickfix list using {list}
|
55
|
1708 setreg( {n}, {v}[, {opt}]) Number set register to value and type
|
831
|
1709 settabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window
|
|
1710 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr} to {val}
|
7
|
1711 setwinvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window {nr} to {val}
|
55
|
1712 simplify( {filename}) String simplify filename as much as possible
|
82
|
1713 sort( {list} [, {func}]) List sort {list}, using {func} to compare
|
374
|
1714 soundfold( {word}) String sound-fold {word}
|
344
|
1715 spellbadword() String badly spelled word at cursor
|
537
|
1716 spellsuggest( {word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
|
|
1717 List spelling suggestions
|
282
|
1718 split( {expr} [, {pat} [, {keepempty}]])
|
685
|
1719 List make |List| from {pat} separated {expr}
|
782
|
1720 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) Number convert string to number
|
7
|
1721 strftime( {format}[, {time}]) String time in specified format
|
133
|
1722 stridx( {haystack}, {needle}[, {start}])
|
|
1723 Number index of {needle} in {haystack}
|
95
|
1724 string( {expr}) String String representation of {expr} value
|
7
|
1725 strlen( {expr}) Number length of the String {expr}
|
|
1726 strpart( {src}, {start}[, {len}])
|
|
1727 String {len} characters of {src} at {start}
|
140
|
1728 strridx( {haystack}, {needle} [, {start}])
|
|
1729 Number last index of {needle} in {haystack}
|
7
|
1730 strtrans( {expr}) String translate string to make it printable
|
55
|
1731 submatch( {nr}) String specific match in ":substitute"
|
7
|
1732 substitute( {expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags})
|
|
1733 String all {pat} in {expr} replaced with {sub}
|
32
|
1734 synID( {lnum}, {col}, {trans}) Number syntax ID at {lnum} and {col}
|
7
|
1735 synIDattr( {synID}, {what} [, {mode}])
|
|
1736 String attribute {what} of syntax ID {synID}
|
|
1737 synIDtrans( {synID}) Number translated syntax ID of {synID}
|
24
|
1738 system( {expr} [, {input}]) String output of shell command/filter {expr}
|
677
|
1739 tabpagebuflist( [{arg}]) List list of buffer numbers in tab page
|
|
1740 tabpagenr( [{arg}]) Number number of current or last tab page
|
|
1741 tabpagewinnr( {tabarg}[, {arg}])
|
|
1742 Number number of current window in tab page
|
|
1743 taglist( {expr}) List list of tags matching {expr}
|
515
|
1744 tagfiles() List tags files used
|
7
|
1745 tempname() String name for a temporary file
|
|
1746 tolower( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to lowercase
|
|
1747 toupper( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to uppercase
|
15
|
1748 tr( {src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) String translate chars of {src} in {fromstr}
|
|
1749 to chars in {tostr}
|
7
|
1750 type( {name}) Number type of variable {name}
|
685
|
1751 values( {dict}) List values in {dict}
|
7
|
1752 virtcol( {expr}) Number screen column of cursor or mark
|
|
1753 visualmode( [expr]) String last visual mode used
|
|
1754 winbufnr( {nr}) Number buffer number of window {nr}
|
|
1755 wincol() Number window column of the cursor
|
|
1756 winheight( {nr}) Number height of window {nr}
|
|
1757 winline() Number window line of the cursor
|
674
|
1758 winnr( [{expr}]) Number number of current window
|
55
|
1759 winrestcmd() String returns command to restore window sizes
|
712
|
1760 winrestview({dict}) None restore view of current window
|
|
1761 winsaveview() Dict save view of current window
|
7
|
1762 winwidth( {nr}) Number width of window {nr}
|
158
|
1763 writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
|
|
1764 Number write list of lines to file {fname}
|
7
|
1765
|
82
|
1766 add({list}, {expr}) *add()*
|
685
|
1767 Append the item {expr} to |List| {list}. Returns the
|
|
1768 resulting |List|. Examples: >
|
82
|
1769 :let alist = add([1, 2, 3], item)
|
|
1770 :call add(mylist, "woodstock")
|
685
|
1771 < Note that when {expr} is a |List| it is appended as a single
|
692
|
1772 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
|
85
|
1773 Use |insert()| to add an item at another position.
|
55
|
1774
|
82
|
1775
|
|
1776 append({lnum}, {expr}) *append()*
|
685
|
1777 When {expr} is a |List|: Append each item of the |List| as a
|
|
1778 text line below line {lnum} in the current buffer.
|
153
|
1779 Otherwise append {expr} as one text line below line {lnum} in
|
|
1780 the current buffer.
|
|
1781 {lnum} can be zero to insert a line before the first one.
|
82
|
1782 Returns 1 for failure ({lnum} out of range or out of memory),
|
|
1783 0 for success. Example: >
|
55
|
1784 :let failed = append(line('$'), "# THE END")
|
82
|
1785 :let failed = append(0, ["Chapter 1", "the beginning"])
|
55
|
1786 <
|
7
|
1787 *argc()*
|
|
1788 argc() The result is the number of files in the argument list of the
|
|
1789 current window. See |arglist|.
|
|
1790
|
|
1791 *argidx()*
|
|
1792 argidx() The result is the current index in the argument list. 0 is
|
|
1793 the first file. argc() - 1 is the last one. See |arglist|.
|
|
1794
|
|
1795 *argv()*
|
818
|
1796 argv([{nr}]) The result is the {nr}th file in the argument list of the
|
7
|
1797 current window. See |arglist|. "argv(0)" is the first one.
|
|
1798 Example: >
|
|
1799 :let i = 0
|
|
1800 :while i < argc()
|
|
1801 : let f = escape(argv(i), '. ')
|
|
1802 : exe 'amenu Arg.' . f . ' :e ' . f . '<CR>'
|
|
1803 : let i = i + 1
|
|
1804 :endwhile
|
818
|
1805 < Without the {nr} argument a |List| with the whole |arglist| is
|
|
1806 returned.
|
|
1807
|
7
|
1808 *browse()*
|
|
1809 browse({save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
|
|
1810 Put up a file requester. This only works when "has("browse")"
|
|
1811 returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
|
|
1812 The input fields are:
|
|
1813 {save} when non-zero, select file to write
|
|
1814 {title} title for the requester
|
|
1815 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
|
|
1816 {default} default file name
|
|
1817 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
|
|
1818 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
|
|
1819
|
29
|
1820 *browsedir()*
|
|
1821 browsedir({title}, {initdir})
|
|
1822 Put up a directory requester. This only works when
|
|
1823 "has("browse")" returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
|
|
1824 On systems where a directory browser is not supported a file
|
|
1825 browser is used. In that case: select a file in the directory
|
|
1826 to be used.
|
|
1827 The input fields are:
|
|
1828 {title} title for the requester
|
|
1829 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
|
|
1830 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
|
|
1831 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
|
|
1832
|
7
|
1833 bufexists({expr}) *bufexists()*
|
|
1834 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1835 {expr} exists.
|
9
|
1836 If the {expr} argument is a number, buffer numbers are used.
|
7
|
1837 If the {expr} argument is a string it must match a buffer name
|
9
|
1838 exactly. The name can be:
|
|
1839 - Relative to the current directory.
|
|
1840 - A full path.
|
|
1841 - The name of a buffer with 'filetype' set to "nofile".
|
|
1842 - A URL name.
|
7
|
1843 Unlisted buffers will be found.
|
|
1844 Note that help files are listed by their short name in the
|
|
1845 output of |:buffers|, but bufexists() requires using their
|
|
1846 long name to be able to find them.
|
|
1847 Use "bufexists(0)" to test for the existence of an alternate
|
|
1848 file name.
|
|
1849 *buffer_exists()*
|
|
1850 Obsolete name: buffer_exists().
|
|
1851
|
|
1852 buflisted({expr}) *buflisted()*
|
|
1853 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1854 {expr} exists and is listed (has the 'buflisted' option set).
|
9
|
1855 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
|
7
|
1856
|
|
1857 bufloaded({expr}) *bufloaded()*
|
|
1858 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
|
|
1859 {expr} exists and is loaded (shown in a window or hidden).
|
9
|
1860 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
|
7
|
1861
|
|
1862 bufname({expr}) *bufname()*
|
|
1863 The result is the name of a buffer, as it is displayed by the
|
|
1864 ":ls" command.
|
|
1865 If {expr} is a Number, that buffer number's name is given.
|
|
1866 Number zero is the alternate buffer for the current window.
|
|
1867 If {expr} is a String, it is used as a |file-pattern| to match
|
|
1868 with the buffer names. This is always done like 'magic' is
|
|
1869 set and 'cpoptions' is empty. When there is more than one
|
|
1870 match an empty string is returned.
|
|
1871 "" or "%" can be used for the current buffer, "#" for the
|
|
1872 alternate buffer.
|
|
1873 A full match is preferred, otherwise a match at the start, end
|
|
1874 or middle of the buffer name is accepted.
|
|
1875 Listed buffers are found first. If there is a single match
|
|
1876 with a listed buffer, that one is returned. Next unlisted
|
|
1877 buffers are searched for.
|
|
1878 If the {expr} is a String, but you want to use it as a buffer
|
|
1879 number, force it to be a Number by adding zero to it: >
|
|
1880 :echo bufname("3" + 0)
|
|
1881 < If the buffer doesn't exist, or doesn't have a name, an empty
|
|
1882 string is returned. >
|
|
1883 bufname("#") alternate buffer name
|
|
1884 bufname(3) name of buffer 3
|
|
1885 bufname("%") name of current buffer
|
|
1886 bufname("file2") name of buffer where "file2" matches.
|
|
1887 < *buffer_name()*
|
|
1888 Obsolete name: buffer_name().
|
|
1889
|
|
1890 *bufnr()*
|
707
|
1891 bufnr({expr} [, {create}])
|
|
1892 The result is the number of a buffer, as it is displayed by
|
7
|
1893 the ":ls" command. For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()|
|
707
|
1894 above.
|
|
1895 If the buffer doesn't exist, -1 is returned. Or, if the
|
|
1896 {create} argument is present and not zero, a new, unlisted,
|
|
1897 buffer is created and its number is returned.
|
7
|
1898 bufnr("$") is the last buffer: >
|
|
1899 :let last_buffer = bufnr("$")
|
|
1900 < The result is a Number, which is the highest buffer number
|
|
1901 of existing buffers. Note that not all buffers with a smaller
|
|
1902 number necessarily exist, because ":bwipeout" may have removed
|
|
1903 them. Use bufexists() to test for the existence of a buffer.
|
|
1904 *buffer_number()*
|
|
1905 Obsolete name: buffer_number().
|
|
1906 *last_buffer_nr()*
|
|
1907 Obsolete name for bufnr("$"): last_buffer_nr().
|
|
1908
|
|
1909 bufwinnr({expr}) *bufwinnr()*
|
|
1910 The result is a Number, which is the number of the first
|
|
1911 window associated with buffer {expr}. For the use of {expr},
|
|
1912 see |bufname()| above. If buffer {expr} doesn't exist or
|
|
1913 there is no such window, -1 is returned. Example: >
|
|
1914
|
|
1915 echo "A window containing buffer 1 is " . (bufwinnr(1))
|
|
1916
|
|
1917 < The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
|
|
1918 |:wincmd|.
|
|
1919
|
|
1920
|
|
1921 byte2line({byte}) *byte2line()*
|
|
1922 Return the line number that contains the character at byte
|
|
1923 count {byte} in the current buffer. This includes the
|
|
1924 end-of-line character, depending on the 'fileformat' option
|
|
1925 for the current buffer. The first character has byte count
|
|
1926 one.
|
|
1927 Also see |line2byte()|, |go| and |:goto|.
|
|
1928 {not available when compiled without the |+byte_offset|
|
|
1929 feature}
|
|
1930
|
18
|
1931 byteidx({expr}, {nr}) *byteidx()*
|
|
1932 Return byte index of the {nr}'th character in the string
|
|
1933 {expr}. Use zero for the first character, it returns zero.
|
|
1934 This function is only useful when there are multibyte
|
|
1935 characters, otherwise the returned value is equal to {nr}.
|
|
1936 Composing characters are counted as a separate character.
|
|
1937 Example : >
|
|
1938 echo matchstr(str, ".", byteidx(str, 3))
|
|
1939 < will display the fourth character. Another way to do the
|
|
1940 same: >
|
|
1941 let s = strpart(str, byteidx(str, 3))
|
|
1942 echo strpart(s, 0, byteidx(s, 1))
|
|
1943 < If there are less than {nr} characters -1 is returned.
|
|
1944 If there are exactly {nr} characters the length of the string
|
|
1945 is returned.
|
|
1946
|
102
|
1947 call({func}, {arglist} [, {dict}]) *call()* *E699*
|
685
|
1948 Call function {func} with the items in |List| {arglist} as
|
79
|
1949 arguments.
|
685
|
1950 {func} can either be a |Funcref| or the name of a function.
|
79
|
1951 a:firstline and a:lastline are set to the cursor line.
|
|
1952 Returns the return value of the called function.
|
102
|
1953 {dict} is for functions with the "dict" attribute. It will be
|
|
1954 used to set the local variable "self". |Dictionary-function|
|
79
|
1955
|
777
|
1956 changenr() *changenr()*
|
|
1957 Return the number of the most recent change. This is the same
|
|
1958 number as what is displayed with |:undolist| and can be used
|
|
1959 with the |:undo| command.
|
|
1960 When a change was made it is the number of that change. After
|
|
1961 redo it is the number of the redone change. After undo it is
|
|
1962 one less than the number of the undone change.
|
|
1963
|
7
|
1964 char2nr({expr}) *char2nr()*
|
|
1965 Return number value of the first char in {expr}. Examples: >
|
|
1966 char2nr(" ") returns 32
|
|
1967 char2nr("ABC") returns 65
|
|
1968 < The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
|
653
|
1969 char2nr("?") returns 225
|
|
1970 char2nr("?"[0]) returns 195
|
236
|
1971 < nr2char() does the opposite.
|
7
|
1972
|
|
1973 cindent({lnum}) *cindent()*
|
|
1974 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the C
|
|
1975 indenting rules, as with 'cindent'.
|
|
1976 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
|
|
1977 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
|
|
1978 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the |+cindent|
|
|
1979 feature, -1 is returned.
|
548
|
1980 See |C-indenting|.
|
7
|
1981
|
|
1982 *col()*
|
24
|
1983 col({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the byte index of the column
|
7
|
1984 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
|
|
1985 . the cursor position
|
|
1986 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
|
|
1987 number of characters in the cursor line plus one)
|
|
1988 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
1989 returned)
|
703
|
1990 To get the line number use |col()|. To get both use
|
|
1991 |getpos()|.
|
7
|
1992 For the screen column position use |virtcol()|.
|
|
1993 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
|
|
1994 Examples: >
|
|
1995 col(".") column of cursor
|
|
1996 col("$") length of cursor line plus one
|
|
1997 col("'t") column of mark t
|
|
1998 col("'" . markname) column of mark markname
|
|
1999 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
|
|
2000 For the cursor position, when 'virtualedit' is active, the
|
|
2001 column is one higher if the cursor is after the end of the
|
|
2002 line. This can be used to obtain the column in Insert mode: >
|
|
2003 :imap <F2> <C-O>:let save_ve = &ve<CR>
|
|
2004 \<C-O>:set ve=all<CR>
|
|
2005 \<C-O>:echo col(".") . "\n" <Bar>
|
|
2006 \let &ve = save_ve<CR>
|
|
2007 <
|
464
|
2008
|
724
|
2009 complete({startcol}, {matches}) *complete()* *E785*
|
|
2010 Set the matches for Insert mode completion.
|
|
2011 Can only be used in Insert mode. You need to use a mapping
|
|
2012 with an expression argument |:map-<expr>| or CTRL-R =
|
|
2013 |i_CTRL-R|. It does not work after CTRL-O.
|
|
2014 {startcol} is the byte offset in the line where the completed
|
|
2015 text start. The text up to the cursor is the original text
|
|
2016 that will be replaced by the matches. Use col('.') for an
|
|
2017 empty string. "col('.') - 1" will replace one character by a
|
|
2018 match.
|
|
2019 {matches} must be a |List|. Each |List| item is one match.
|
|
2020 See |complete-items| for the kind of items that are possible.
|
|
2021 Note that the after calling this function you need to avoid
|
|
2022 inserting anything that would completion to stop.
|
|
2023 The match can be selected with CTRL-N and CTRL-P as usual with
|
|
2024 Insert mode completion. The popup menu will appear if
|
|
2025 specified, see |ins-completion-menu|.
|
|
2026 Example: >
|
|
2027 inoremap <expr> <F5> ListMonths()
|
|
2028
|
|
2029 func! ListMonths()
|
|
2030 call complete(col('.'), ['January', 'February', 'March',
|
|
2031 \ 'April', 'May', 'June', 'July', 'August', 'September',
|
|
2032 \ 'October', 'November', 'December'])
|
|
2033 return ''
|
|
2034 endfunc
|
|
2035 < This isn't very useful, but it shows how it works. Note that
|
|
2036 an empty string is returned to avoid a zero being inserted.
|
|
2037
|
464
|
2038 complete_add({expr}) *complete_add()*
|
|
2039 Add {expr} to the list of matches. Only to be used by the
|
|
2040 function specified with the 'completefunc' option.
|
|
2041 Returns 0 for failure (empty string or out of memory),
|
|
2042 1 when the match was added, 2 when the match was already in
|
|
2043 the list.
|
786
|
2044 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of {expr}. It is
|
|
2045 the same as one item in the list that 'omnifunc' would return.
|
464
|
2046
|
|
2047 complete_check() *complete_check()*
|
|
2048 Check for a key typed while looking for completion matches.
|
|
2049 This is to be used when looking for matches takes some time.
|
|
2050 Returns non-zero when searching for matches is to be aborted,
|
|
2051 zero otherwise.
|
|
2052 Only to be used by the function specified with the
|
|
2053 'completefunc' option.
|
|
2054
|
7
|
2055 *confirm()*
|
|
2056 confirm({msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
|
|
2057 Confirm() offers the user a dialog, from which a choice can be
|
|
2058 made. It returns the number of the choice. For the first
|
|
2059 choice this is 1.
|
|
2060 Note: confirm() is only supported when compiled with dialog
|
|
2061 support, see |+dialog_con| and |+dialog_gui|.
|
|
2062 {msg} is displayed in a |dialog| with {choices} as the
|
|
2063 alternatives. When {choices} is missing or empty, "&OK" is
|
|
2064 used (and translated).
|
|
2065 {msg} is a String, use '\n' to include a newline. Only on
|
|
2066 some systems the string is wrapped when it doesn't fit.
|
|
2067 {choices} is a String, with the individual choices separated
|
|
2068 by '\n', e.g. >
|
|
2069 confirm("Save changes?", "&Yes\n&No\n&Cancel")
|
|
2070 < The letter after the '&' is the shortcut key for that choice.
|
|
2071 Thus you can type 'c' to select "Cancel". The shortcut does
|
|
2072 not need to be the first letter: >
|
|
2073 confirm("file has been modified", "&Save\nSave &All")
|
|
2074 < For the console, the first letter of each choice is used as
|
|
2075 the default shortcut key.
|
|
2076 The optional {default} argument is the number of the choice
|
|
2077 that is made if the user hits <CR>. Use 1 to make the first
|
|
2078 choice the default one. Use 0 to not set a default. If
|
|
2079 {default} is omitted, 1 is used.
|
|
2080 The optional {type} argument gives the type of dialog. This
|
|
2081 is only used for the icon of the Win32 GUI. It can be one of
|
|
2082 these values: "Error", "Question", "Info", "Warning" or
|
|
2083 "Generic". Only the first character is relevant. When {type}
|
|
2084 is omitted, "Generic" is used.
|
|
2085 If the user aborts the dialog by pressing <Esc>, CTRL-C,
|
|
2086 or another valid interrupt key, confirm() returns 0.
|
|
2087
|
|
2088 An example: >
|
|
2089 :let choice = confirm("What do you want?", "&Apples\n&Oranges\n&Bananas", 2)
|
|
2090 :if choice == 0
|
|
2091 : echo "make up your mind!"
|
|
2092 :elseif choice == 3
|
|
2093 : echo "tasteful"
|
|
2094 :else
|
|
2095 : echo "I prefer bananas myself."
|
|
2096 :endif
|
|
2097 < In a GUI dialog, buttons are used. The layout of the buttons
|
|
2098 depends on the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. If it is included,
|
|
2099 the buttons are always put vertically. Otherwise, confirm()
|
|
2100 tries to put the buttons in one horizontal line. If they
|
|
2101 don't fit, a vertical layout is used anyway. For some systems
|
|
2102 the horizontal layout is always used.
|
|
2103
|
55
|
2104 *copy()*
|
|
2105 copy({expr}) Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
|
|
2106 different from using {expr} directly.
|
685
|
2107 When {expr} is a |List| a shallow copy is created. This means
|
|
2108 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
|
55
|
2109 copy, and vise versa. But the items are identical, thus
|
692
|
2110 changing an item changes the contents of both |Lists|. Also
|
685
|
2111 see |deepcopy()|.
|
55
|
2112
|
102
|
2113 count({comp}, {expr} [, {ic} [, {start}]]) *count()*
|
79
|
2114 Return the number of times an item with value {expr} appears
|
685
|
2115 in |List| or |Dictionary| {comp}.
|
102
|
2116 If {start} is given then start with the item with this index.
|
685
|
2117 {start} can only be used with a |List|.
|
79
|
2118 When {ic} is given and it's non-zero then case is ignored.
|
|
2119
|
|
2120
|
7
|
2121 *cscope_connection()*
|
|
2122 cscope_connection([{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
|
|
2123 Checks for the existence of a |cscope| connection. If no
|
|
2124 parameters are specified, then the function returns:
|
|
2125 0, if cscope was not available (not compiled in), or
|
|
2126 if there are no cscope connections;
|
|
2127 1, if there is at least one cscope connection.
|
|
2128
|
|
2129 If parameters are specified, then the value of {num}
|
|
2130 determines how existence of a cscope connection is checked:
|
|
2131
|
|
2132 {num} Description of existence check
|
|
2133 ----- ------------------------------
|
|
2134 0 Same as no parameters (e.g., "cscope_connection()").
|
|
2135 1 Ignore {prepend}, and use partial string matches for
|
|
2136 {dbpath}.
|
|
2137 2 Ignore {prepend}, and use exact string matches for
|
|
2138 {dbpath}.
|
|
2139 3 Use {prepend}, use partial string matches for both
|
|
2140 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
|
|
2141 4 Use {prepend}, use exact string matches for both
|
|
2142 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
|
|
2143
|
|
2144 Note: All string comparisons are case sensitive!
|
|
2145
|
|
2146 Examples. Suppose we had the following (from ":cs show"): >
|
|
2147
|
|
2148 # pid database name prepend path
|
|
2149 0 27664 cscope.out /usr/local
|
|
2150 <
|
|
2151 Invocation Return Val ~
|
|
2152 ---------- ---------- >
|
|
2153 cscope_connection() 1
|
|
2154 cscope_connection(1, "out") 1
|
|
2155 cscope_connection(2, "out") 0
|
|
2156 cscope_connection(3, "out") 0
|
|
2157 cscope_connection(3, "out", "local") 1
|
|
2158 cscope_connection(4, "out") 0
|
|
2159 cscope_connection(4, "out", "local") 0
|
|
2160 cscope_connection(4, "cscope.out", "/usr/local") 1
|
|
2161 <
|
703
|
2162 cursor({lnum}, {col} [, {off}]) *cursor()*
|
|
2163 cursor({list})
|
7
|
2164 Positions the cursor at the column {col} in the line {lnum}.
|
493
|
2165 The first column is one.
|
703
|
2166 When there is one argument {list} this is used as a |List|
|
707
|
2167 with two or three items {lnum}, {col} and {off}. This is like
|
|
2168 the return value of |getpos()|, but without the first item.
|
7
|
2169 Does not change the jumplist.
|
|
2170 If {lnum} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
|
|
2171 the cursor will be positioned at the last line in the buffer.
|
|
2172 If {lnum} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current line.
|
493
|
2173 If {col} is greater than the number of bytes in the line,
|
7
|
2174 the cursor will be positioned at the last character in the
|
|
2175 line.
|
|
2176 If {col} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current column.
|
703
|
2177 When 'virtualedit' is used {off} specifies the offset in
|
|
2178 screen columns from the start of the character. E.g., a
|
|
2179 position within a Tab or after the last character.
|
7
|
2180
|
55
|
2181
|
164
|
2182 deepcopy({expr}[, {noref}]) *deepcopy()* *E698*
|
55
|
2183 Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
|
|
2184 different from using {expr} directly.
|
685
|
2185 When {expr} is a |List| a full copy is created. This means
|
|
2186 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
|
|
2187 copy, and vise versa. When an item is a |List|, a copy for it
|
55
|
2188 is made, recursively. Thus changing an item in the copy does
|
685
|
2189 not change the contents of the original |List|.
|
|
2190 When {noref} is omitted or zero a contained |List| or
|
|
2191 |Dictionary| is only copied once. All references point to
|
|
2192 this single copy. With {noref} set to 1 every occurrence of a
|
|
2193 |List| or |Dictionary| results in a new copy. This also means
|
|
2194 that a cyclic reference causes deepcopy() to fail.
|
114
|
2195 *E724*
|
|
2196 Nesting is possible up to 100 levels. When there is an item
|
164
|
2197 that refers back to a higher level making a deep copy with
|
|
2198 {noref} set to 1 will fail.
|
55
|
2199 Also see |copy()|.
|
|
2200
|
|
2201 delete({fname}) *delete()*
|
|
2202 Deletes the file by the name {fname}. The result is a Number,
|
7
|
2203 which is 0 if the file was deleted successfully, and non-zero
|
|
2204 when the deletion failed.
|
685
|
2205 Use |remove()| to delete an item from a |List|.
|
7
|
2206
|
|
2207 *did_filetype()*
|
|
2208 did_filetype() Returns non-zero when autocommands are being executed and the
|
|
2209 FileType event has been triggered at least once. Can be used
|
|
2210 to avoid triggering the FileType event again in the scripts
|
|
2211 that detect the file type. |FileType|
|
|
2212 When editing another file, the counter is reset, thus this
|
|
2213 really checks if the FileType event has been triggered for the
|
|
2214 current buffer. This allows an autocommand that starts
|
|
2215 editing another buffer to set 'filetype' and load a syntax
|
|
2216 file.
|
|
2217
|
32
|
2218 diff_filler({lnum}) *diff_filler()*
|
|
2219 Returns the number of filler lines above line {lnum}.
|
|
2220 These are the lines that were inserted at this point in
|
|
2221 another diff'ed window. These filler lines are shown in the
|
|
2222 display but don't exist in the buffer.
|
|
2223 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2224 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2225 Returns 0 if the current window is not in diff mode.
|
|
2226
|
|
2227 diff_hlID({lnum}, {col}) *diff_hlID()*
|
|
2228 Returns the highlight ID for diff mode at line {lnum} column
|
|
2229 {col} (byte index). When the current line does not have a
|
|
2230 diff change zero is returned.
|
|
2231 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2232 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2233 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
|
|
2234 line.
|
|
2235 The highlight ID can be used with |synIDattr()| to obtain
|
|
2236 syntax information about the highlighting.
|
|
2237
|
85
|
2238 empty({expr}) *empty()*
|
|
2239 Return the Number 1 if {expr} is empty, zero otherwise.
|
685
|
2240 A |List| or |Dictionary| is empty when it does not have any
|
|
2241 items. A Number is empty when its value is zero.
|
|
2242 For a long |List| this is much faster then comparing the
|
|
2243 length with zero.
|
85
|
2244
|
7
|
2245 escape({string}, {chars}) *escape()*
|
|
2246 Escape the characters in {chars} that occur in {string} with a
|
|
2247 backslash. Example: >
|
|
2248 :echo escape('c:\program files\vim', ' \')
|
|
2249 < results in: >
|
|
2250 c:\\program\ files\\vim
|
95
|
2251
|
|
2252 < *eval()*
|
|
2253 eval({string}) Evaluate {string} and return the result. Especially useful to
|
|
2254 turn the result of |string()| back into the original value.
|
|
2255 This works for Numbers, Strings and composites of them.
|
685
|
2256 Also works for |Funcref|s that refer to existing functions.
|
95
|
2257
|
7
|
2258 eventhandler() *eventhandler()*
|
|
2259 Returns 1 when inside an event handler. That is that Vim got
|
|
2260 interrupted while waiting for the user to type a character,
|
|
2261 e.g., when dropping a file on Vim. This means interactive
|
|
2262 commands cannot be used. Otherwise zero is returned.
|
|
2263
|
|
2264 executable({expr}) *executable()*
|
|
2265 This function checks if an executable with the name {expr}
|
|
2266 exists. {expr} must be the name of the program without any
|
10
|
2267 arguments.
|
|
2268 executable() uses the value of $PATH and/or the normal
|
|
2269 searchpath for programs. *PATHEXT*
|
|
2270 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows the ".exe", ".bat", etc. can
|
|
2271 optionally be included. Then the extensions in $PATHEXT are
|
|
2272 tried. Thus if "foo.exe" does not exist, "foo.exe.bat" can be
|
|
2273 found. If $PATHEXT is not set then ".exe;.com;.bat;.cmd" is
|
|
2274 used. A dot by itself can be used in $PATHEXT to try using
|
|
2275 the name without an extension. When 'shell' looks like a
|
|
2276 Unix shell, then the name is also tried without adding an
|
|
2277 extension.
|
|
2278 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows it only checks if the file exists and
|
|
2279 is not a directory, not if it's really executable.
|
819
|
2280 On MS-Windows an executable in the same directory as Vim is
|
|
2281 always found. Since this directory is added to $PATH it
|
|
2282 should also work to execute it |win32-PATH|.
|
7
|
2283 The result is a Number:
|
|
2284 1 exists
|
|
2285 0 does not exist
|
|
2286 -1 not implemented on this system
|
|
2287
|
|
2288 *exists()*
|
|
2289 exists({expr}) The result is a Number, which is non-zero if {expr} is
|
|
2290 defined, zero otherwise. The {expr} argument is a string,
|
|
2291 which contains one of these:
|
|
2292 &option-name Vim option (only checks if it exists,
|
|
2293 not if it really works)
|
|
2294 +option-name Vim option that works.
|
|
2295 $ENVNAME environment variable (could also be
|
|
2296 done by comparing with an empty
|
|
2297 string)
|
|
2298 *funcname built-in function (see |functions|)
|
|
2299 or user defined function (see
|
|
2300 |user-functions|).
|
|
2301 varname internal variable (see
|
158
|
2302 |internal-variables|). Also works
|
685
|
2303 for |curly-braces-names|, |Dictionary|
|
|
2304 entries, |List| items, etc. Beware
|
|
2305 that this may cause functions to be
|
158
|
2306 invoked cause an error message for an
|
|
2307 invalid expression.
|
7
|
2308 :cmdname Ex command: built-in command, user
|
|
2309 command or command modifier |:command|.
|
|
2310 Returns:
|
|
2311 1 for match with start of a command
|
|
2312 2 full match with a command
|
|
2313 3 matches several user commands
|
|
2314 To check for a supported command
|
|
2315 always check the return value to be 2.
|
864
|
2316 :2match The |:2match| command.
|
|
2317 :3match The |:3match| command.
|
7
|
2318 #event autocommand defined for this event
|
|
2319 #event#pattern autocommand defined for this event and
|
|
2320 pattern (the pattern is taken
|
|
2321 literally and compared to the
|
|
2322 autocommand patterns character by
|
|
2323 character)
|
613
|
2324 #group autocommand group exists
|
|
2325 #group#event autocommand defined for this group and
|
|
2326 event.
|
|
2327 #group#event#pattern
|
856
|
2328 autocommand defined for this group,
|
613
|
2329 event and pattern.
|
615
|
2330 ##event autocommand for this event is
|
|
2331 supported.
|
7
|
2332 For checking for a supported feature use |has()|.
|
|
2333
|
|
2334 Examples: >
|
|
2335 exists("&shortname")
|
|
2336 exists("$HOSTNAME")
|
|
2337 exists("*strftime")
|
|
2338 exists("*s:MyFunc")
|
|
2339 exists("bufcount")
|
|
2340 exists(":Make")
|
613
|
2341 exists("#CursorHold")
|
7
|
2342 exists("#BufReadPre#*.gz")
|
613
|
2343 exists("#filetypeindent")
|
|
2344 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType")
|
|
2345 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType#*")
|
615
|
2346 exists("##ColorScheme")
|
7
|
2347 < There must be no space between the symbol (&/$/*/#) and the
|
|
2348 name.
|
867
|
2349 There must be no extra characters after the name, although in
|
|
2350 a few cases this is ignored. That may become more strict in
|
|
2351 the future, thus don't count on it!
|
|
2352 Working example: >
|
|
2353 exists(":make")
|
|
2354 < NOT working example: >
|
|
2355 exists(":make install")
|
859
|
2356
|
|
2357 < Note that the argument must be a string, not the name of the
|
|
2358 variable itself. For example: >
|
7
|
2359 exists(bufcount)
|
|
2360 < This doesn't check for existence of the "bufcount" variable,
|
853
|
2361 but gets the value of "bufcount", and checks if that exists.
|
7
|
2362
|
|
2363 expand({expr} [, {flag}]) *expand()*
|
|
2364 Expand wildcards and the following special keywords in {expr}.
|
|
2365 The result is a String.
|
|
2366
|
|
2367 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
|
|
2368 characters. [Note: in version 5.0 a space was used, which
|
|
2369 caused problems when a file name contains a space]
|
|
2370
|
|
2371 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string. A name
|
|
2372 for a non-existing file is not included.
|
|
2373
|
|
2374 When {expr} starts with '%', '#' or '<', the expansion is done
|
|
2375 like for the |cmdline-special| variables with their associated
|
|
2376 modifiers. Here is a short overview:
|
|
2377
|
|
2378 % current file name
|
|
2379 # alternate file name
|
|
2380 #n alternate file name n
|
|
2381 <cfile> file name under the cursor
|
|
2382 <afile> autocmd file name
|
|
2383 <abuf> autocmd buffer number (as a String!)
|
|
2384 <amatch> autocmd matched name
|
|
2385 <sfile> sourced script file name
|
|
2386 <cword> word under the cursor
|
|
2387 <cWORD> WORD under the cursor
|
|
2388 <client> the {clientid} of the last received
|
|
2389 message |server2client()|
|
|
2390 Modifiers:
|
|
2391 :p expand to full path
|
|
2392 :h head (last path component removed)
|
|
2393 :t tail (last path component only)
|
|
2394 :r root (one extension removed)
|
|
2395 :e extension only
|
|
2396
|
|
2397 Example: >
|
|
2398 :let &tags = expand("%:p:h") . "/tags"
|
|
2399 < Note that when expanding a string that starts with '%', '#' or
|
|
2400 '<', any following text is ignored. This does NOT work: >
|
|
2401 :let doesntwork = expand("%:h.bak")
|
|
2402 < Use this: >
|
|
2403 :let doeswork = expand("%:h") . ".bak"
|
|
2404 < Also note that expanding "<cfile>" and others only returns the
|
|
2405 referenced file name without further expansion. If "<cfile>"
|
|
2406 is "~/.cshrc", you need to do another expand() to have the
|
|
2407 "~/" expanded into the path of the home directory: >
|
|
2408 :echo expand(expand("<cfile>"))
|
|
2409 <
|
|
2410 There cannot be white space between the variables and the
|
|
2411 following modifier. The |fnamemodify()| function can be used
|
|
2412 to modify normal file names.
|
|
2413
|
|
2414 When using '%' or '#', and the current or alternate file name
|
|
2415 is not defined, an empty string is used. Using "%:p" in a
|
|
2416 buffer with no name, results in the current directory, with a
|
|
2417 '/' added.
|
|
2418
|
|
2419 When {expr} does not start with '%', '#' or '<', it is
|
|
2420 expanded like a file name is expanded on the command line.
|
|
2421 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' are used, unless the optional
|
|
2422 {flag} argument is given and it is non-zero. Names for
|
444
|
2423 non-existing files are included. The "**" item can be used to
|
|
2424 search in a directory tree. For example, to find all "README"
|
|
2425 files in the current directory and below: >
|
|
2426 :echo expand("**/README")
|
|
2427 <
|
7
|
2428 Expand() can also be used to expand variables and environment
|
|
2429 variables that are only known in a shell. But this can be
|
|
2430 slow, because a shell must be started. See |expr-env-expand|.
|
|
2431 The expanded variable is still handled like a list of file
|
|
2432 names. When an environment variable cannot be expanded, it is
|
|
2433 left unchanged. Thus ":echo expand('$FOOBAR')" results in
|
|
2434 "$FOOBAR".
|
|
2435
|
|
2436 See |glob()| for finding existing files. See |system()| for
|
|
2437 getting the raw output of an external command.
|
|
2438
|
102
|
2439 extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}]) *extend()*
|
692
|
2440 {expr1} and {expr2} must be both |Lists| or both
|
|
2441 |Dictionaries|.
|
|
2442
|
|
2443 If they are |Lists|: Append {expr2} to {expr1}.
|
102
|
2444 If {expr3} is given insert the items of {expr2} before item
|
|
2445 {expr3} in {expr1}. When {expr3} is zero insert before the
|
|
2446 first item. When {expr3} is equal to len({expr1}) then
|
|
2447 {expr2} is appended.
|
79
|
2448 Examples: >
|
|
2449 :echo sort(extend(mylist, [7, 5]))
|
|
2450 :call extend(mylist, [2, 3], 1)
|
82
|
2451 < Use |add()| to concatenate one item to a list. To concatenate
|
|
2452 two lists into a new list use the + operator: >
|
79
|
2453 :let newlist = [1, 2, 3] + [4, 5]
|
102
|
2454 <
|
692
|
2455 If they are |Dictionaries|:
|
102
|
2456 Add all entries from {expr2} to {expr1}.
|
|
2457 If a key exists in both {expr1} and {expr2} then {expr3} is
|
|
2458 used to decide what to do:
|
|
2459 {expr3} = "keep": keep the value of {expr1}
|
|
2460 {expr3} = "force": use the value of {expr2}
|
856
|
2461 {expr3} = "error": give an error message *E737*
|
102
|
2462 When {expr3} is omitted then "force" is assumed.
|
|
2463
|
|
2464 {expr1} is changed when {expr2} is not empty. If necessary
|
|
2465 make a copy of {expr1} first.
|
|
2466 {expr2} remains unchanged.
|
|
2467 Returns {expr1}.
|
|
2468
|
79
|
2469
|
842
|
2470 feedkeys({string} [, {mode}]) *feedkeys()*
|
|
2471 Characters in {string} are queued for processing as if they
|
843
|
2472 come from a mapping or were typed by user. They are added to
|
842
|
2473 the end of the typeahead buffer, thus if a mapping is still
|
|
2474 being executed these characters come after them.
|
|
2475 The function does not wait for processing of keys contained in
|
|
2476 {string}.
|
|
2477 To include special keys into {string}, use double-quotes
|
|
2478 and "\..." notation |expr-quote|. For example,
|
|
2479 feedkeys("\<CR>") simulates pressing of the Enter key. But
|
|
2480 feedkeys('\<CR>') pushes 5 characters.
|
|
2481 If {mode} is absent, keys are remapped.
|
|
2482 {mode} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
|
843
|
2483 'm' Remap keys. This is default.
|
|
2484 'n' Do not remap keys.
|
|
2485 't' Handle keys as if typed; otherwise they are handled as
|
|
2486 if coming from a mapping. This matters for undo,
|
|
2487 opening folds, etc.
|
842
|
2488 Return value is always 0.
|
|
2489
|
7
|
2490 filereadable({file}) *filereadable()*
|
|
2491 The result is a Number, which is TRUE when a file with the
|
|
2492 name {file} exists, and can be read. If {file} doesn't exist,
|
|
2493 or is a directory, the result is FALSE. {file} is any
|
|
2494 expression, which is used as a String.
|
|
2495 *file_readable()*
|
|
2496 Obsolete name: file_readable().
|
|
2497
|
95
|
2498
|
102
|
2499 filter({expr}, {string}) *filter()*
|
685
|
2500 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
2501 For each item in {expr} evaluate {string} and when the result
|
685
|
2502 is zero remove the item from the |List| or |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
2503 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
|
685
|
2504 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
|
102
|
2505 Examples: >
|
|
2506 :call filter(mylist, 'v:val !~ "OLD"')
|
|
2507 < Removes the items where "OLD" appears. >
|
|
2508 :call filter(mydict, 'v:key >= 8')
|
|
2509 < Removes the items with a key below 8. >
|
|
2510 :call filter(var, 0)
|
685
|
2511 < Removes all the items, thus clears the |List| or |Dictionary|.
|
99
|
2512
|
102
|
2513 Note that {string} is the result of expression and is then
|
|
2514 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
|
|
2515 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes.
|
|
2516
|
685
|
2517 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
|
|
2518 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
650
|
2519 :let l = filter(copy(mylist), 'v:val =~ "KEEP"')
|
102
|
2520
|
685
|
2521 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
|
648
|
2522 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
|
|
2523 further items in {expr} are processed.
|
95
|
2524
|
|
2525
|
19
|
2526 finddir({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *finddir()*
|
794
|
2527 Find directory {name} in {path}. Returns the path of the
|
|
2528 first found match. When the found directory is below the
|
|
2529 current directory a relative path is returned. Otherwise a
|
|
2530 full path is returned.
|
19
|
2531 If {path} is omitted or empty then 'path' is used.
|
|
2532 If the optional {count} is given, find {count}'s occurrence of
|
794
|
2533 {name} in {path} instead of the first one.
|
809
|
2534 When {count} is negative return all the matches in a |List|.
|
19
|
2535 This is quite similar to the ex-command |:find|.
|
794
|
2536 {only available when compiled with the +file_in_path feature}
|
|
2537
|
|
2538 findfile({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *findfile()*
|
|
2539 Just like |finddir()|, but find a file instead of a directory.
|
|
2540 Uses 'suffixesadd'.
|
19
|
2541 Example: >
|
|
2542 :echo findfile("tags.vim", ".;")
|
|
2543 < Searches from the current directory upwards until it finds
|
|
2544 the file "tags.vim".
|
|
2545
|
7
|
2546 filewritable({file}) *filewritable()*
|
|
2547 The result is a Number, which is 1 when a file with the
|
|
2548 name {file} exists, and can be written. If {file} doesn't
|
|
2549 exist, or is not writable, the result is 0. If (file) is a
|
|
2550 directory, and we can write to it, the result is 2.
|
|
2551
|
|
2552 fnamemodify({fname}, {mods}) *fnamemodify()*
|
|
2553 Modify file name {fname} according to {mods}. {mods} is a
|
|
2554 string of characters like it is used for file names on the
|
|
2555 command line. See |filename-modifiers|.
|
|
2556 Example: >
|
|
2557 :echo fnamemodify("main.c", ":p:h")
|
|
2558 < results in: >
|
|
2559 /home/mool/vim/vim/src
|
|
2560 < Note: Environment variables and "~" don't work in {fname}, use
|
|
2561 |expand()| first then.
|
|
2562
|
|
2563 foldclosed({lnum}) *foldclosed()*
|
|
2564 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
|
|
2565 fold, the result is the number of the first line in that fold.
|
|
2566 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
|
|
2567
|
|
2568 foldclosedend({lnum}) *foldclosedend()*
|
|
2569 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
|
|
2570 fold, the result is the number of the last line in that fold.
|
|
2571 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
|
|
2572
|
|
2573 foldlevel({lnum}) *foldlevel()*
|
|
2574 The result is a Number, which is the foldlevel of line {lnum}
|
|
2575 in the current buffer. For nested folds the deepest level is
|
|
2576 returned. If there is no fold at line {lnum}, zero is
|
|
2577 returned. It doesn't matter if the folds are open or closed.
|
|
2578 When used while updating folds (from 'foldexpr') -1 is
|
|
2579 returned for lines where folds are still to be updated and the
|
|
2580 foldlevel is unknown. As a special case the level of the
|
|
2581 previous line is usually available.
|
|
2582
|
|
2583 *foldtext()*
|
|
2584 foldtext() Returns a String, to be displayed for a closed fold. This is
|
|
2585 the default function used for the 'foldtext' option and should
|
|
2586 only be called from evaluating 'foldtext'. It uses the
|
|
2587 |v:foldstart|, |v:foldend| and |v:folddashes| variables.
|
|
2588 The returned string looks like this: >
|
|
2589 +-- 45 lines: abcdef
|
|
2590 < The number of dashes depends on the foldlevel. The "45" is
|
|
2591 the number of lines in the fold. "abcdef" is the text in the
|
|
2592 first non-blank line of the fold. Leading white space, "//"
|
|
2593 or "/*" and the text from the 'foldmarker' and 'commentstring'
|
|
2594 options is removed.
|
|
2595 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
|
|
2596
|
29
|
2597 foldtextresult({lnum}) *foldtextresult()*
|
|
2598 Returns the text that is displayed for the closed fold at line
|
|
2599 {lnum}. Evaluates 'foldtext' in the appropriate context.
|
|
2600 When there is no closed fold at {lnum} an empty string is
|
|
2601 returned.
|
|
2602 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
|
|
2603 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
|
|
2604 Useful when exporting folded text, e.g., to HTML.
|
|
2605 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
|
|
2606
|
7
|
2607 *foreground()*
|
|
2608 foreground() Move the Vim window to the foreground. Useful when sent from
|
|
2609 a client to a Vim server. |remote_send()|
|
|
2610 On Win32 systems this might not work, the OS does not always
|
|
2611 allow a window to bring itself to the foreground. Use
|
|
2612 |remote_foreground()| instead.
|
|
2613 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
|
|
2614 Win32 console version}
|
|
2615
|
82
|
2616
|
85
|
2617 function({name}) *function()* *E700*
|
685
|
2618 Return a |Funcref| variable that refers to function {name}.
|
55
|
2619 {name} can be a user defined function or an internal function.
|
|
2620
|
82
|
2621
|
370
|
2622 garbagecollect() *garbagecollect()*
|
692
|
2623 Cleanup unused |Lists| and |Dictionaries| that have circular
|
370
|
2624 references. There is hardly ever a need to invoke this
|
|
2625 function, as it is automatically done when Vim runs out of
|
|
2626 memory or is waiting for the user to press a key after
|
|
2627 'updatetime'. Items without circular references are always
|
|
2628 freed when they become unused.
|
685
|
2629 This is useful if you have deleted a very big |List| and/or
|
|
2630 |Dictionary| with circular references in a script that runs
|
|
2631 for a long time.
|
370
|
2632
|
140
|
2633 get({list}, {idx} [, {default}]) *get()*
|
685
|
2634 Get item {idx} from |List| {list}. When this item is not
|
82
|
2635 available return {default}. Return zero when {default} is
|
|
2636 omitted.
|
102
|
2637 get({dict}, {key} [, {default}])
|
685
|
2638 Get item with key {key} from |Dictionary| {dict}. When this
|
102
|
2639 item is not available return {default}. Return zero when
|
|
2640 {default} is omitted.
|
|
2641
|
435
|
2642 *getbufline()*
|
|
2643 getbufline({expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
|
685
|
2644 Return a |List| with the lines starting from {lnum} to {end}
|
|
2645 (inclusive) in the buffer {expr}. If {end} is omitted, a
|
|
2646 |List| with only the line {lnum} is returned.
|
435
|
2647
|
|
2648 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
2649
|
448
|
2650 For {lnum} and {end} "$" can be used for the last line of the
|
|
2651 buffer. Otherwise a number must be used.
|
435
|
2652
|
|
2653 When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
|
685
|
2654 lines in the buffer, an empty |List| is returned.
|
435
|
2655
|
|
2656 When {end} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
|
|
2657 it is treated as {end} is set to the number of lines in the
|
685
|
2658 buffer. When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is
|
435
|
2659 returned.
|
|
2660
|
448
|
2661 This function works only for loaded buffers. For unloaded and
|
685
|
2662 non-existing buffers, an empty |List| is returned.
|
435
|
2663
|
|
2664 Example: >
|
|
2665 :let lines = getbufline(bufnr("myfile"), 1, "$")
|
82
|
2666
|
|
2667 getbufvar({expr}, {varname}) *getbufvar()*
|
|
2668 The result is the value of option or local buffer variable
|
|
2669 {varname} in buffer {expr}. Note that the name without "b:"
|
|
2670 must be used.
|
216
|
2671 This also works for a global or buffer-local option, but it
|
|
2672 doesn't work for a global variable, window-local variable or
|
|
2673 window-local option.
|
82
|
2674 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
2675 When the buffer or variable doesn't exist an empty string is
|
|
2676 returned, there is no error message.
|
|
2677 Examples: >
|
|
2678 :let bufmodified = getbufvar(1, "&mod")
|
|
2679 :echo "todo myvar = " . getbufvar("todo", "myvar")
|
|
2680 <
|
7
|
2681 getchar([expr]) *getchar()*
|
867
|
2682 Get a single character from the user or input stream.
|
7
|
2683 If [expr] is omitted, wait until a character is available.
|
|
2684 If [expr] is 0, only get a character when one is available.
|
867
|
2685 Return zero otherwise.
|
7
|
2686 If [expr] is 1, only check if a character is available, it is
|
867
|
2687 not consumed. Return zero if no character available.
|
|
2688
|
|
2689 Without {expr} and when {expr} is 0 a whole character or
|
|
2690 special key is returned. If it is an 8-bit character, the
|
|
2691 result is a number. Use nr2char() to convert it to a String.
|
|
2692 Otherwise a String is returned with the encoded character.
|
|
2693 For a special key it's a sequence of bytes starting with 0x80
|
872
|
2694 (decimal: 128). This is the same value as the string
|
|
2695 "\<Key>", e.g., "\<Left>". The returned value is also a
|
|
2696 String when a modifier (shift, control, alt) was used that is
|
|
2697 not included in the character.
|
867
|
2698
|
|
2699 When {expr} is 1 only the first byte is returned. For a
|
872
|
2700 one-byte character it is the character itself as a number.
|
|
2701 Use nr2char() to convert it to a String.
|
867
|
2702
|
7
|
2703 There is no prompt, you will somehow have to make clear to the
|
|
2704 user that a character has to be typed.
|
|
2705 There is no mapping for the character.
|
|
2706 Key codes are replaced, thus when the user presses the <Del>
|
|
2707 key you get the code for the <Del> key, not the raw character
|
|
2708 sequence. Examples: >
|
|
2709 getchar() == "\<Del>"
|
|
2710 getchar() == "\<S-Left>"
|
|
2711 < This example redefines "f" to ignore case: >
|
|
2712 :nmap f :call FindChar()<CR>
|
|
2713 :function FindChar()
|
|
2714 : let c = nr2char(getchar())
|
|
2715 : while col('.') < col('$') - 1
|
|
2716 : normal l
|
|
2717 : if getline('.')[col('.') - 1] ==? c
|
|
2718 : break
|
|
2719 : endif
|
|
2720 : endwhile
|
|
2721 :endfunction
|
|
2722
|
|
2723 getcharmod() *getcharmod()*
|
|
2724 The result is a Number which is the state of the modifiers for
|
|
2725 the last obtained character with getchar() or in another way.
|
|
2726 These values are added together:
|
|
2727 2 shift
|
|
2728 4 control
|
|
2729 8 alt (meta)
|
|
2730 16 mouse double click
|
|
2731 32 mouse triple click
|
|
2732 64 mouse quadruple click
|
|
2733 128 Macintosh only: command
|
|
2734 Only the modifiers that have not been included in the
|
|
2735 character itself are obtained. Thus Shift-a results in "A"
|
|
2736 with no modifier.
|
|
2737
|
|
2738 getcmdline() *getcmdline()*
|
|
2739 Return the current command-line. Only works when the command
|
|
2740 line is being edited, thus requires use of |c_CTRL-\_e| or
|
|
2741 |c_CTRL-R_=|.
|
|
2742 Example: >
|
|
2743 :cmap <F7> <C-\>eescape(getcmdline(), ' \')<CR>
|
531
|
2744 < Also see |getcmdtype()|, |getcmdpos()| and |setcmdpos()|.
|
7
|
2745
|
95
|
2746 getcmdpos() *getcmdpos()*
|
7
|
2747 Return the position of the cursor in the command line as a
|
|
2748 byte count. The first column is 1.
|
|
2749 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
|
|
2750 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns 0 otherwise.
|
531
|
2751 Also see |getcmdtype()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
|
|
2752
|
|
2753 getcmdtype() *getcmdtype()*
|
|
2754 Return the current command-line type. Possible return values
|
|
2755 are:
|
532
|
2756 : normal Ex command
|
|
2757 > debug mode command |debug-mode|
|
|
2758 / forward search command
|
|
2759 ? backward search command
|
|
2760 @ |input()| command
|
|
2761 - |:insert| or |:append| command
|
531
|
2762 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
|
|
2763 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns an empty string
|
|
2764 otherwise.
|
|
2765 Also see |getcmdpos()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
|
7
|
2766
|
|
2767 *getcwd()*
|
|
2768 getcwd() The result is a String, which is the name of the current
|
|
2769 working directory.
|
|
2770
|
|
2771 getfsize({fname}) *getfsize()*
|
|
2772 The result is a Number, which is the size in bytes of the
|
|
2773 given file {fname}.
|
|
2774 If {fname} is a directory, 0 is returned.
|
|
2775 If the file {fname} can't be found, -1 is returned.
|
|
2776
|
37
|
2777 getfontname([{name}]) *getfontname()*
|
|
2778 Without an argument returns the name of the normal font being
|
|
2779 used. Like what is used for the Normal highlight group
|
|
2780 |hl-Normal|.
|
|
2781 With an argument a check is done whether {name} is a valid
|
|
2782 font name. If not then an empty string is returned.
|
|
2783 Otherwise the actual font name is returned, or {name} if the
|
|
2784 GUI does not support obtaining the real name.
|
824
|
2785 Only works when the GUI is running, thus not in your vimrc or
|
819
|
2786 gvimrc file. Use the |GUIEnter| autocommand to use this
|
|
2787 function just after the GUI has started.
|
37
|
2788 Note that the GTK 2 GUI accepts any font name, thus checking
|
|
2789 for a valid name does not work.
|
|
2790
|
20
|
2791 getfperm({fname}) *getfperm()*
|
|
2792 The result is a String, which is the read, write, and execute
|
|
2793 permissions of the given file {fname}.
|
|
2794 If {fname} does not exist or its directory cannot be read, an
|
|
2795 empty string is returned.
|
|
2796 The result is of the form "rwxrwxrwx", where each group of
|
|
2797 "rwx" flags represent, in turn, the permissions of the owner
|
|
2798 of the file, the group the file belongs to, and other users.
|
|
2799 If a user does not have a given permission the flag for this
|
|
2800 is replaced with the string "-". Example: >
|
|
2801 :echo getfperm("/etc/passwd")
|
|
2802 < This will hopefully (from a security point of view) display
|
|
2803 the string "rw-r--r--" or even "rw-------".
|
205
|
2804
|
7
|
2805 getftime({fname}) *getftime()*
|
|
2806 The result is a Number, which is the last modification time of
|
|
2807 the given file {fname}. The value is measured as seconds
|
|
2808 since 1st Jan 1970, and may be passed to strftime(). See also
|
|
2809 |localtime()| and |strftime()|.
|
|
2810 If the file {fname} can't be found -1 is returned.
|
|
2811
|
20
|
2812 getftype({fname}) *getftype()*
|
|
2813 The result is a String, which is a description of the kind of
|
|
2814 file of the given file {fname}.
|
|
2815 If {fname} does not exist an empty string is returned.
|
|
2816 Here is a table over different kinds of files and their
|
|
2817 results:
|
|
2818 Normal file "file"
|
|
2819 Directory "dir"
|
|
2820 Symbolic link "link"
|
|
2821 Block device "bdev"
|
|
2822 Character device "cdev"
|
|
2823 Socket "socket"
|
|
2824 FIFO "fifo"
|
|
2825 All other "other"
|
|
2826 Example: >
|
|
2827 getftype("/home")
|
|
2828 < Note that a type such as "link" will only be returned on
|
|
2829 systems that support it. On some systems only "dir" and
|
|
2830 "file" are returned.
|
|
2831
|
7
|
2832 *getline()*
|
82
|
2833 getline({lnum} [, {end}])
|
|
2834 Without {end} the result is a String, which is line {lnum}
|
|
2835 from the current buffer. Example: >
|
7
|
2836 getline(1)
|
|
2837 < When {lnum} is a String that doesn't start with a
|
|
2838 digit, line() is called to translate the String into a Number.
|
|
2839 To get the line under the cursor: >
|
|
2840 getline(".")
|
|
2841 < When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
|
|
2842 lines in the buffer, an empty string is returned.
|
|
2843
|
685
|
2844 When {end} is given the result is a |List| where each item is
|
|
2845 a line from the current buffer in the range {lnum} to {end},
|
82
|
2846 including line {end}.
|
|
2847 {end} is used in the same way as {lnum}.
|
|
2848 Non-existing lines are silently omitted.
|
685
|
2849 When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is returned.
|
82
|
2850 Example: >
|
|
2851 :let start = line('.')
|
|
2852 :let end = search("^$") - 1
|
|
2853 :let lines = getline(start, end)
|
|
2854
|
647
|
2855 getloclist({nr}) *getloclist()*
|
|
2856 Returns a list with all the entries in the location list for
|
|
2857 window {nr}. When {nr} is zero the current window is used.
|
|
2858 For a location list window, the displayed location list is
|
648
|
2859 returned. For an invalid window number {nr}, an empty list is
|
|
2860 returned. Otherwise, same as getqflist().
|
82
|
2861
|
230
|
2862 getqflist() *getqflist()*
|
|
2863 Returns a list with all the current quickfix errors. Each
|
|
2864 list item is a dictionary with these entries:
|
|
2865 bufnr number of buffer that has the file name, use
|
|
2866 bufname() to get the name
|
|
2867 lnum line number in the buffer (first line is 1)
|
|
2868 col column number (first column is 1)
|
233
|
2869 vcol non-zero: "col" is visual column
|
|
2870 zero: "col" is byte index
|
230
|
2871 nr error number
|
|
2872 text description of the error
|
|
2873 type type of the error, 'E', '1', etc.
|
|
2874 valid non-zero: recognized error message
|
|
2875
|
515
|
2876 When there is no error list or it's empty an empty list is
|
|
2877 returned.
|
|
2878
|
230
|
2879 Useful application: Find pattern matches in multiple files and
|
|
2880 do something with them: >
|
|
2881 :vimgrep /theword/jg *.c
|
|
2882 :for d in getqflist()
|
|
2883 : echo bufname(d.bufnr) ':' d.lnum '=' d.text
|
|
2884 :endfor
|
|
2885
|
|
2886
|
282
|
2887 getreg([{regname} [, 1]]) *getreg()*
|
7
|
2888 The result is a String, which is the contents of register
|
236
|
2889 {regname}. Example: >
|
7
|
2890 :let cliptext = getreg('*')
|
|
2891 < getreg('=') returns the last evaluated value of the expression
|
236
|
2892 register. (For use in maps.)
|
282
|
2893 getreg('=', 1) returns the expression itself, so that it can
|
|
2894 be restored with |setreg()|. For other registers the extra
|
|
2895 argument is ignored, thus you can always give it.
|
7
|
2896 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
|
|
2897
|
82
|
2898
|
7
|
2899 getregtype([{regname}]) *getregtype()*
|
|
2900 The result is a String, which is type of register {regname}.
|
|
2901 The value will be one of:
|
|
2902 "v" for |characterwise| text
|
|
2903 "V" for |linewise| text
|
|
2904 "<CTRL-V>{width}" for |blockwise-visual| text
|
|
2905 0 for an empty or unknown register
|
|
2906 <CTRL-V> is one character with value 0x16.
|
|
2907 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
|
|
2908
|
831
|
2909 gettabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}) *gettabwinvar()*
|
|
2910 Get the value of an option or local window variable {varname}
|
|
2911 in window {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}.
|
|
2912 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
|
|
2913 use |getwinvar()|.
|
|
2914 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
|
|
2915 This also works for a global option, buffer-local option and
|
|
2916 window-local option, but it doesn't work for a global variable
|
|
2917 or buffer-local variable.
|
|
2918 Note that the name without "w:" must be used.
|
|
2919 Examples: >
|
|
2920 :let list_is_on = gettabwinvar(1, 2, '&list')
|
|
2921 :echo "myvar = " . gettabwinvar(3, 1, 'myvar')
|
|
2922
|
7
|
2923 *getwinposx()*
|
|
2924 getwinposx() The result is a Number, which is the X coordinate in pixels of
|
|
2925 the left hand side of the GUI Vim window. The result will be
|
|
2926 -1 if the information is not available.
|
|
2927
|
|
2928 *getwinposy()*
|
|
2929 getwinposy() The result is a Number, which is the Y coordinate in pixels of
|
|
2930 the top of the GUI Vim window. The result will be -1 if the
|
|
2931 information is not available.
|
|
2932
|
831
|
2933 getwinvar({winnr}, {varname}) *getwinvar()*
|
|
2934 Like |gettabwinvar()| for the current tabpage.
|
7
|
2935 Examples: >
|
|
2936 :let list_is_on = getwinvar(2, '&list')
|
|
2937 :echo "myvar = " . getwinvar(1, 'myvar')
|
|
2938 <
|
|
2939 *glob()*
|
|
2940 glob({expr}) Expand the file wildcards in {expr}. The result is a String.
|
|
2941 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
|
|
2942 characters.
|
|
2943 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string.
|
|
2944 A name for a non-existing file is not included.
|
|
2945
|
|
2946 For most systems backticks can be used to get files names from
|
|
2947 any external command. Example: >
|
|
2948 :let tagfiles = glob("`find . -name tags -print`")
|
|
2949 :let &tags = substitute(tagfiles, "\n", ",", "g")
|
|
2950 < The result of the program inside the backticks should be one
|
|
2951 item per line. Spaces inside an item are allowed.
|
|
2952
|
|
2953 See |expand()| for expanding special Vim variables. See
|
|
2954 |system()| for getting the raw output of an external command.
|
|
2955
|
|
2956 globpath({path}, {expr}) *globpath()*
|
|
2957 Perform glob() on all directories in {path} and concatenate
|
|
2958 the results. Example: >
|
|
2959 :echo globpath(&rtp, "syntax/c.vim")
|
|
2960 < {path} is a comma-separated list of directory names. Each
|
|
2961 directory name is prepended to {expr} and expanded like with
|
|
2962 glob(). A path separator is inserted when needed.
|
|
2963 To add a comma inside a directory name escape it with a
|
|
2964 backslash. Note that on MS-Windows a directory may have a
|
|
2965 trailing backslash, remove it if you put a comma after it.
|
|
2966 If the expansion fails for one of the directories, there is no
|
|
2967 error message.
|
|
2968 The 'wildignore' option applies: Names matching one of the
|
|
2969 patterns in 'wildignore' will be skipped.
|
|
2970
|
444
|
2971 The "**" item can be used to search in a directory tree.
|
|
2972 For example, to find all "README.txt" files in the directories
|
|
2973 in 'runtimepath' and below: >
|
|
2974 :echo globpath(&rtp, "**/README.txt")
|
|
2975 <
|
7
|
2976 *has()*
|
|
2977 has({feature}) The result is a Number, which is 1 if the feature {feature} is
|
|
2978 supported, zero otherwise. The {feature} argument is a
|
|
2979 string. See |feature-list| below.
|
|
2980 Also see |exists()|.
|
|
2981
|
102
|
2982
|
|
2983 has_key({dict}, {key}) *has_key()*
|
685
|
2984 The result is a Number, which is 1 if |Dictionary| {dict} has
|
|
2985 an entry with key {key}. Zero otherwise.
|
102
|
2986
|
|
2987
|
782
|
2988 hasmapto({what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *hasmapto()*
|
7
|
2989 The result is a Number, which is 1 if there is a mapping that
|
|
2990 contains {what} in somewhere in the rhs (what it is mapped to)
|
|
2991 and this mapping exists in one of the modes indicated by
|
|
2992 {mode}.
|
782
|
2993 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
786
|
2994 instead of mappings. Don't forget to specify Insert and/or
|
|
2995 Command-line mode.
|
7
|
2996 Both the global mappings and the mappings local to the current
|
|
2997 buffer are checked for a match.
|
|
2998 If no matching mapping is found 0 is returned.
|
|
2999 The following characters are recognized in {mode}:
|
|
3000 n Normal mode
|
|
3001 v Visual mode
|
|
3002 o Operator-pending mode
|
|
3003 i Insert mode
|
|
3004 l Language-Argument ("r", "f", "t", etc.)
|
|
3005 c Command-line mode
|
|
3006 When {mode} is omitted, "nvo" is used.
|
|
3007
|
|
3008 This function is useful to check if a mapping already exists
|
|
3009 to a function in a Vim script. Example: >
|
|
3010 :if !hasmapto('\ABCdoit')
|
|
3011 : map <Leader>d \ABCdoit
|
|
3012 :endif
|
|
3013 < This installs the mapping to "\ABCdoit" only if there isn't
|
|
3014 already a mapping to "\ABCdoit".
|
|
3015
|
|
3016 histadd({history}, {item}) *histadd()*
|
|
3017 Add the String {item} to the history {history} which can be
|
|
3018 one of: *hist-names*
|
|
3019 "cmd" or ":" command line history
|
|
3020 "search" or "/" search pattern history
|
|
3021 "expr" or "=" typed expression history
|
|
3022 "input" or "@" input line history
|
|
3023 If {item} does already exist in the history, it will be
|
|
3024 shifted to become the newest entry.
|
|
3025 The result is a Number: 1 if the operation was successful,
|
|
3026 otherwise 0 is returned.
|
|
3027
|
|
3028 Example: >
|
|
3029 :call histadd("input", strftime("%Y %b %d"))
|
|
3030 :let date=input("Enter date: ")
|
|
3031 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3032
|
|
3033 histdel({history} [, {item}]) *histdel()*
|
236
|
3034 Clear {history}, i.e. delete all its entries. See |hist-names|
|
7
|
3035 for the possible values of {history}.
|
|
3036
|
|
3037 If the parameter {item} is given as String, this is seen
|
|
3038 as regular expression. All entries matching that expression
|
|
3039 will be removed from the history (if there are any).
|
|
3040 Upper/lowercase must match, unless "\c" is used |/\c|.
|
|
3041 If {item} is a Number, it will be interpreted as index, see
|
|
3042 |:history-indexing|. The respective entry will be removed
|
|
3043 if it exists.
|
|
3044
|
|
3045 The result is a Number: 1 for a successful operation,
|
|
3046 otherwise 0 is returned.
|
|
3047
|
|
3048 Examples:
|
|
3049 Clear expression register history: >
|
|
3050 :call histdel("expr")
|
|
3051 <
|
|
3052 Remove all entries starting with "*" from the search history: >
|
|
3053 :call histdel("/", '^\*')
|
|
3054 <
|
|
3055 The following three are equivalent: >
|
|
3056 :call histdel("search", histnr("search"))
|
|
3057 :call histdel("search", -1)
|
|
3058 :call histdel("search", '^'.histget("search", -1).'$')
|
|
3059 <
|
|
3060 To delete the last search pattern and use the last-but-one for
|
|
3061 the "n" command and 'hlsearch': >
|
|
3062 :call histdel("search", -1)
|
|
3063 :let @/ = histget("search", -1)
|
|
3064
|
|
3065 histget({history} [, {index}]) *histget()*
|
|
3066 The result is a String, the entry with Number {index} from
|
|
3067 {history}. See |hist-names| for the possible values of
|
|
3068 {history}, and |:history-indexing| for {index}. If there is
|
|
3069 no such entry, an empty String is returned. When {index} is
|
|
3070 omitted, the most recent item from the history is used.
|
|
3071
|
|
3072 Examples:
|
|
3073 Redo the second last search from history. >
|
|
3074 :execute '/' . histget("search", -2)
|
|
3075
|
|
3076 < Define an Ex command ":H {num}" that supports re-execution of
|
|
3077 the {num}th entry from the output of |:history|. >
|
|
3078 :command -nargs=1 H execute histget("cmd", 0+<args>)
|
|
3079 <
|
|
3080 histnr({history}) *histnr()*
|
|
3081 The result is the Number of the current entry in {history}.
|
|
3082 See |hist-names| for the possible values of {history}.
|
|
3083 If an error occurred, -1 is returned.
|
|
3084
|
|
3085 Example: >
|
|
3086 :let inp_index = histnr("expr")
|
|
3087 <
|
|
3088 hlexists({name}) *hlexists()*
|
|
3089 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a highlight group
|
|
3090 called {name} exists. This is when the group has been
|
|
3091 defined in some way. Not necessarily when highlighting has
|
|
3092 been defined for it, it may also have been used for a syntax
|
|
3093 item.
|
|
3094 *highlight_exists()*
|
|
3095 Obsolete name: highlight_exists().
|
|
3096
|
|
3097 *hlID()*
|
|
3098 hlID({name}) The result is a Number, which is the ID of the highlight group
|
|
3099 with name {name}. When the highlight group doesn't exist,
|
|
3100 zero is returned.
|
|
3101 This can be used to retrieve information about the highlight
|
|
3102 group. For example, to get the background color of the
|
|
3103 "Comment" group: >
|
|
3104 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(hlID("Comment")), "bg")
|
|
3105 < *highlightID()*
|
|
3106 Obsolete name: highlightID().
|
|
3107
|
|
3108 hostname() *hostname()*
|
|
3109 The result is a String, which is the name of the machine on
|
236
|
3110 which Vim is currently running. Machine names greater than
|
7
|
3111 256 characters long are truncated.
|
|
3112
|
|
3113 iconv({expr}, {from}, {to}) *iconv()*
|
|
3114 The result is a String, which is the text {expr} converted
|
|
3115 from encoding {from} to encoding {to}.
|
|
3116 When the conversion fails an empty string is returned.
|
|
3117 The encoding names are whatever the iconv() library function
|
|
3118 can accept, see ":!man 3 iconv".
|
|
3119 Most conversions require Vim to be compiled with the |+iconv|
|
|
3120 feature. Otherwise only UTF-8 to latin1 conversion and back
|
|
3121 can be done.
|
|
3122 This can be used to display messages with special characters,
|
|
3123 no matter what 'encoding' is set to. Write the message in
|
|
3124 UTF-8 and use: >
|
|
3125 echo iconv(utf8_str, "utf-8", &enc)
|
|
3126 < Note that Vim uses UTF-8 for all Unicode encodings, conversion
|
|
3127 from/to UCS-2 is automatically changed to use UTF-8. You
|
|
3128 cannot use UCS-2 in a string anyway, because of the NUL bytes.
|
|
3129 {only available when compiled with the +multi_byte feature}
|
|
3130
|
|
3131 *indent()*
|
|
3132 indent({lnum}) The result is a Number, which is indent of line {lnum} in the
|
|
3133 current buffer. The indent is counted in spaces, the value
|
|
3134 of 'tabstop' is relevant. {lnum} is used just like in
|
|
3135 |getline()|.
|
|
3136 When {lnum} is invalid -1 is returned.
|
|
3137
|
79
|
3138
|
95
|
3139 index({list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]]) *index()*
|
685
|
3140 Return the lowest index in |List| {list} where the item has a
|
79
|
3141 value equal to {expr}.
|
153
|
3142 If {start} is given then start looking at the item with index
|
|
3143 {start} (may be negative for an item relative to the end).
|
79
|
3144 When {ic} is given and it is non-zero, ignore case. Otherwise
|
|
3145 case must match.
|
|
3146 -1 is returned when {expr} is not found in {list}.
|
|
3147 Example: >
|
|
3148 :let idx = index(words, "the")
|
87
|
3149 :if index(numbers, 123) >= 0
|
79
|
3150
|
|
3151
|
531
|
3152 input({prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]]) *input()*
|
7
|
3153 The result is a String, which is whatever the user typed on
|
|
3154 the command-line. The parameter is either a prompt string, or
|
|
3155 a blank string (for no prompt). A '\n' can be used in the
|
531
|
3156 prompt to start a new line.
|
|
3157 The highlighting set with |:echohl| is used for the prompt.
|
|
3158 The input is entered just like a command-line, with the same
|
|
3159 editing commands and mappings. There is a separate history
|
|
3160 for lines typed for input().
|
|
3161 Example: >
|
|
3162 :if input("Coffee or beer? ") == "beer"
|
|
3163 : echo "Cheers!"
|
|
3164 :endif
|
|
3165 <
|
532
|
3166 If the optional {text} is present and not empty, this is used
|
|
3167 for the default reply, as if the user typed this. Example: >
|
531
|
3168 :let color = input("Color? ", "white")
|
|
3169
|
|
3170 < The optional {completion} argument specifies the type of
|
|
3171 completion supported for the input. Without it completion is
|
|
3172 not performed. The supported completion types are the same as
|
|
3173 that can be supplied to a user-defined command using the
|
|
3174 "-complete=" argument. Refer to |:command-completion| for
|
|
3175 more information. Example: >
|
|
3176 let fname = input("File: ", "", "file")
|
|
3177 <
|
|
3178 NOTE: This function must not be used in a startup file, for
|
|
3179 the versions that only run in GUI mode (e.g., the Win32 GUI).
|
7
|
3180 Note: When input() is called from within a mapping it will
|
|
3181 consume remaining characters from that mapping, because a
|
|
3182 mapping is handled like the characters were typed.
|
|
3183 Use |inputsave()| before input() and |inputrestore()|
|
|
3184 after input() to avoid that. Another solution is to avoid
|
|
3185 that further characters follow in the mapping, e.g., by using
|
|
3186 |:execute| or |:normal|.
|
|
3187
|
531
|
3188 Example with a mapping: >
|
7
|
3189 :nmap \x :call GetFoo()<CR>:exe "/" . Foo<CR>
|
|
3190 :function GetFoo()
|
|
3191 : call inputsave()
|
|
3192 : let g:Foo = input("enter search pattern: ")
|
|
3193 : call inputrestore()
|
|
3194 :endfunction
|
|
3195
|
|
3196 inputdialog({prompt} [, {text} [, {cancelreturn}]]) *inputdialog()*
|
|
3197 Like input(), but when the GUI is running and text dialogs are
|
|
3198 supported, a dialog window pops up to input the text.
|
|
3199 Example: >
|
|
3200 :let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", &sw)
|
|
3201 :if n != ""
|
|
3202 : let &sw = n
|
|
3203 :endif
|
|
3204 < When the dialog is cancelled {cancelreturn} is returned. When
|
|
3205 omitted an empty string is returned.
|
|
3206 Hitting <Enter> works like pressing the OK button. Hitting
|
|
3207 <Esc> works like pressing the Cancel button.
|
531
|
3208 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
|
7
|
3209
|
519
|
3210 inputlist({textlist}) *inputlist()*
|
819
|
3211 {textlist} must be a |List| of strings. This |List| is
|
|
3212 displayed, one string per line. The user will be prompted to
|
|
3213 enter a number, which is returned.
|
519
|
3214 The user can also select an item by clicking on it with the
|
|
3215 mouse. For the first string 0 is returned. When clicking
|
|
3216 above the first item a negative number is returned. When
|
|
3217 clicking on the prompt one more than the length of {textlist}
|
|
3218 is returned.
|
|
3219 Make sure {textlist} has less then 'lines' entries, otherwise
|
|
3220 it won't work. It's a good idea to put the entry number at
|
|
3221 the start of the string. Example: >
|
|
3222 let color = inputlist(['Select color:', '1. red',
|
|
3223 \ '2. green', '3. blue'])
|
|
3224
|
7
|
3225 inputrestore() *inputrestore()*
|
|
3226 Restore typeahead that was saved with a previous inputsave().
|
|
3227 Should be called the same number of times inputsave() is
|
|
3228 called. Calling it more often is harmless though.
|
|
3229 Returns 1 when there is nothing to restore, 0 otherwise.
|
|
3230
|
|
3231 inputsave() *inputsave()*
|
|
3232 Preserve typeahead (also from mappings) and clear it, so that
|
|
3233 a following prompt gets input from the user. Should be
|
|
3234 followed by a matching inputrestore() after the prompt. Can
|
|
3235 be used several times, in which case there must be just as
|
|
3236 many inputrestore() calls.
|
|
3237 Returns 1 when out of memory, 0 otherwise.
|
|
3238
|
|
3239 inputsecret({prompt} [, {text}]) *inputsecret()*
|
|
3240 This function acts much like the |input()| function with but
|
|
3241 two exceptions:
|
|
3242 a) the user's response will be displayed as a sequence of
|
|
3243 asterisks ("*") thereby keeping the entry secret, and
|
|
3244 b) the user's response will not be recorded on the input
|
|
3245 |history| stack.
|
|
3246 The result is a String, which is whatever the user actually
|
|
3247 typed on the command-line in response to the issued prompt.
|
531
|
3248 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
|
7
|
3249
|
55
|
3250 insert({list}, {item} [, {idx}]) *insert()*
|
685
|
3251 Insert {item} at the start of |List| {list}.
|
55
|
3252 If {idx} is specified insert {item} before the item with index
|
|
3253 {idx}. If {idx} is zero it goes before the first item, just
|
|
3254 like omitting {idx}. A negative {idx} is also possible, see
|
|
3255 |list-index|. -1 inserts just before the last item.
|
685
|
3256 Returns the resulting |List|. Examples: >
|
55
|
3257 :let mylist = insert([2, 3, 5], 1)
|
|
3258 :call insert(mylist, 4, -1)
|
|
3259 :call insert(mylist, 6, len(mylist))
|
82
|
3260 < The last example can be done simpler with |add()|.
|
685
|
3261 Note that when {item} is a |List| it is inserted as a single
|
692
|
3262 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
|
55
|
3263
|
7
|
3264 isdirectory({directory}) *isdirectory()*
|
|
3265 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when a directory
|
|
3266 with the name {directory} exists. If {directory} doesn't
|
|
3267 exist, or isn't a directory, the result is FALSE. {directory}
|
|
3268 is any expression, which is used as a String.
|
|
3269
|
819
|
3270 islocked({expr}) *islocked()* *E786*
|
148
|
3271 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when {expr} is the
|
|
3272 name of a locked variable.
|
685
|
3273 {expr} must be the name of a variable, |List| item or
|
|
3274 |Dictionary| entry, not the variable itself! Example: >
|
148
|
3275 :let alist = [0, ['a', 'b'], 2, 3]
|
|
3276 :lockvar 1 alist
|
|
3277 :echo islocked('alist') " 1
|
|
3278 :echo islocked('alist[1]') " 0
|
|
3279
|
|
3280 < When {expr} is a variable that does not exist you get an error
|
843
|
3281 message. Use |exists()| to check for existence.
|
148
|
3282
|
140
|
3283 items({dict}) *items()*
|
685
|
3284 Return a |List| with all the key-value pairs of {dict}. Each
|
|
3285 |List| item is a list with two items: the key of a {dict}
|
|
3286 entry and the value of this entry. The |List| is in arbitrary
|
|
3287 order.
|
140
|
3288
|
95
|
3289
|
|
3290 join({list} [, {sep}]) *join()*
|
|
3291 Join the items in {list} together into one String.
|
|
3292 When {sep} is specified it is put in between the items. If
|
|
3293 {sep} is omitted a single space is used.
|
|
3294 Note that {sep} is not added at the end. You might want to
|
|
3295 add it there too: >
|
|
3296 let lines = join(mylist, "\n") . "\n"
|
692
|
3297 < String items are used as-is. |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are
|
95
|
3298 converted into a string like with |string()|.
|
|
3299 The opposite function is |split()|.
|
|
3300
|
99
|
3301 keys({dict}) *keys()*
|
685
|
3302 Return a |List| with all the keys of {dict}. The |List| is in
|
99
|
3303 arbitrary order.
|
|
3304
|
85
|
3305 *len()* *E701*
|
55
|
3306 len({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the argument.
|
|
3307 When {expr} is a String or a Number the length in bytes is
|
|
3308 used, as with |strlen()|.
|
685
|
3309 When {expr} is a |List| the number of items in the |List| is
|
55
|
3310 returned.
|
685
|
3311 When {expr} is a |Dictionary| the number of entries in the
|
|
3312 |Dictionary| is returned.
|
55
|
3313 Otherwise an error is given.
|
|
3314
|
7
|
3315 *libcall()* *E364* *E368*
|
|
3316 libcall({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
|
|
3317 Call function {funcname} in the run-time library {libname}
|
|
3318 with single argument {argument}.
|
|
3319 This is useful to call functions in a library that you
|
|
3320 especially made to be used with Vim. Since only one argument
|
|
3321 is possible, calling standard library functions is rather
|
|
3322 limited.
|
|
3323 The result is the String returned by the function. If the
|
|
3324 function returns NULL, this will appear as an empty string ""
|
|
3325 to Vim.
|
|
3326 If the function returns a number, use libcallnr()!
|
|
3327 If {argument} is a number, it is passed to the function as an
|
|
3328 int; if {argument} is a string, it is passed as a
|
|
3329 null-terminated string.
|
|
3330 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
|
|
3331
|
|
3332 libcall() allows you to write your own 'plug-in' extensions to
|
|
3333 Vim without having to recompile the program. It is NOT a
|
|
3334 means to call system functions! If you try to do so Vim will
|
|
3335 very probably crash.
|
|
3336
|
|
3337 For Win32, the functions you write must be placed in a DLL
|
|
3338 and use the normal C calling convention (NOT Pascal which is
|
|
3339 used in Windows System DLLs). The function must take exactly
|
|
3340 one parameter, either a character pointer or a long integer,
|
|
3341 and must return a character pointer or NULL. The character
|
|
3342 pointer returned must point to memory that will remain valid
|
|
3343 after the function has returned (e.g. in static data in the
|
|
3344 DLL). If it points to allocated memory, that memory will
|
|
3345 leak away. Using a static buffer in the function should work,
|
|
3346 it's then freed when the DLL is unloaded.
|
|
3347
|
|
3348 WARNING: If the function returns a non-valid pointer, Vim may
|
|
3349 crash! This also happens if the function returns a number,
|
|
3350 because Vim thinks it's a pointer.
|
|
3351 For Win32 systems, {libname} should be the filename of the DLL
|
|
3352 without the ".DLL" suffix. A full path is only required if
|
|
3353 the DLL is not in the usual places.
|
|
3354 For Unix: When compiling your own plugins, remember that the
|
|
3355 object code must be compiled as position-independent ('PIC').
|
|
3356 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
|
|
3357 feature is present}
|
|
3358 Examples: >
|
|
3359 :echo libcall("libc.so", "getenv", "HOME")
|
|
3360 :echo libcallnr("/usr/lib/libc.so", "getpid", "")
|
|
3361 <
|
|
3362 *libcallnr()*
|
|
3363 libcallnr({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
|
|
3364 Just like libcall(), but used for a function that returns an
|
|
3365 int instead of a string.
|
|
3366 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
|
|
3367 feature is present}
|
|
3368 Example (not very useful...): >
|
|
3369 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "printf", "Hello World!\n")
|
|
3370 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "sleep", 10)
|
|
3371 <
|
|
3372 *line()*
|
|
3373 line({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the line number of the file
|
|
3374 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
|
|
3375 . the cursor position
|
|
3376 $ the last line in the current buffer
|
|
3377 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
3378 returned)
|
665
|
3379 w0 first line visible in current window
|
|
3380 w$ last line visible in current window
|
707
|
3381 Note that a mark in another file can be used.
|
703
|
3382 To get the column number use |col()|. To get both use
|
|
3383 |getpos()|.
|
7
|
3384 Examples: >
|
|
3385 line(".") line number of the cursor
|
|
3386 line("'t") line number of mark t
|
|
3387 line("'" . marker) line number of mark marker
|
|
3388 < *last-position-jump*
|
|
3389 This autocommand jumps to the last known position in a file
|
|
3390 just after opening it, if the '" mark is set: >
|
|
3391 :au BufReadPost * if line("'\"") > 0 && line("'\"") <= line("$") | exe "normal g'\"" | endif
|
9
|
3392
|
7
|
3393 line2byte({lnum}) *line2byte()*
|
|
3394 Return the byte count from the start of the buffer for line
|
|
3395 {lnum}. This includes the end-of-line character, depending on
|
|
3396 the 'fileformat' option for the current buffer. The first
|
|
3397 line returns 1.
|
|
3398 This can also be used to get the byte count for the line just
|
|
3399 below the last line: >
|
|
3400 line2byte(line("$") + 1)
|
|
3401 < This is the file size plus one.
|
|
3402 When {lnum} is invalid, or the |+byte_offset| feature has been
|
|
3403 disabled at compile time, -1 is returned.
|
|
3404 Also see |byte2line()|, |go| and |:goto|.
|
|
3405
|
|
3406 lispindent({lnum}) *lispindent()*
|
|
3407 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the lisp
|
|
3408 indenting rules, as with 'lisp'.
|
|
3409 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
|
|
3410 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
|
|
3411 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the
|
|
3412 |+lispindent| feature, -1 is returned.
|
|
3413
|
|
3414 localtime() *localtime()*
|
|
3415 Return the current time, measured as seconds since 1st Jan
|
|
3416 1970. See also |strftime()| and |getftime()|.
|
|
3417
|
95
|
3418
|
102
|
3419 map({expr}, {string}) *map()*
|
685
|
3420 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
|
102
|
3421 Replace each item in {expr} with the result of evaluating
|
|
3422 {string}.
|
|
3423 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
|
685
|
3424 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
|
102
|
3425 Example: >
|
|
3426 :call map(mylist, '"> " . v:val . " <"')
|
95
|
3427 < This puts "> " before and " <" after each item in "mylist".
|
102
|
3428
|
158
|
3429 Note that {string} is the result of an expression and is then
|
102
|
3430 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
|
158
|
3431 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes. You
|
|
3432 still have to double ' quotes
|
102
|
3433
|
685
|
3434 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
|
|
3435 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
99
|
3436 :let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' & . "\t"')
|
102
|
3437
|
685
|
3438 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
|
648
|
3439 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
|
|
3440 further items in {expr} are processed.
|
95
|
3441
|
|
3442
|
782
|
3443 maparg({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *maparg()*
|
7
|
3444 Return the rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}. When there
|
|
3445 is no mapping for {name}, an empty String is returned.
|
644
|
3446 {mode} can be one of these strings:
|
7
|
3447 "n" Normal
|
|
3448 "v" Visual
|
|
3449 "o" Operator-pending
|
|
3450 "i" Insert
|
|
3451 "c" Cmd-line
|
|
3452 "l" langmap |language-mapping|
|
|
3453 "" Normal, Visual and Operator-pending
|
644
|
3454 When {mode} is omitted, the modes for "" are used.
|
782
|
3455 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
|
3456 instead of mappings.
|
7
|
3457 The {name} can have special key names, like in the ":map"
|
|
3458 command. The returned String has special characters
|
|
3459 translated like in the output of the ":map" command listing.
|
|
3460 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
|
|
3461 then the global mappings.
|
626
|
3462 This function can be used to map a key even when it's already
|
|
3463 mapped, and have it do the original mapping too. Sketch: >
|
|
3464 exe 'nnoremap <Tab> ==' . maparg('<Tab>', 'n')
|
|
3465
|
7
|
3466
|
782
|
3467 mapcheck({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *mapcheck()*
|
7
|
3468 Check if there is a mapping that matches with {name} in mode
|
|
3469 {mode}. See |maparg()| for {mode} and special names in
|
|
3470 {name}.
|
782
|
3471 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
|
|
3472 instead of mappings.
|
7
|
3473 A match happens with a mapping that starts with {name} and
|
|
3474 with a mapping which is equal to the start of {name}.
|
|
3475
|
|
3476 matches mapping "a" "ab" "abc" ~
|
|
3477 mapcheck("a") yes yes yes
|
|
3478 mapcheck("abc") yes yes yes
|
|
3479 mapcheck("ax") yes no no
|
|
3480 mapcheck("b") no no no
|
|
3481
|
|
3482 The difference with maparg() is that mapcheck() finds a
|
|
3483 mapping that matches with {name}, while maparg() only finds a
|
|
3484 mapping for {name} exactly.
|
|
3485 When there is no mapping that starts with {name}, an empty
|
|
3486 String is returned. If there is one, the rhs of that mapping
|
|
3487 is returned. If there are several mappings that start with
|
|
3488 {name}, the rhs of one of them is returned.
|
|
3489 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
|
|
3490 then the global mappings.
|
|
3491 This function can be used to check if a mapping can be added
|
|
3492 without being ambiguous. Example: >
|
|
3493 :if mapcheck("_vv") == ""
|
|
3494 : map _vv :set guifont=7x13<CR>
|
|
3495 :endif
|
|
3496 < This avoids adding the "_vv" mapping when there already is a
|
|
3497 mapping for "_v" or for "_vvv".
|
|
3498
|
19
|
3499 match({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *match()*
|
685
|
3500 When {expr} is a |List| then this returns the index of the
|
|
3501 first item where {pat} matches. Each item is used as a
|
692
|
3502 String, |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are used as echoed.
|
95
|
3503 Otherwise, {expr} is used as a String. The result is a
|
|
3504 Number, which gives the index (byte offset) in {expr} where
|
|
3505 {pat} matches.
|
685
|
3506 A match at the first character or |List| item returns zero.
|
19
|
3507 If there is no match -1 is returned.
|
|
3508 Example: >
|
95
|
3509 :echo match("testing", "ing") " results in 4
|
714
|
3510 :echo match([1, 'x'], '\a') " results in 1
|
95
|
3511 < See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
|
170
|
3512 *strpbrk()*
|
|
3513 Vim doesn't have a strpbrk() function. But you can do: >
|
|
3514 :let sepidx = match(line, '[.,;: \t]')
|
|
3515 < *strcasestr()*
|
|
3516 Vim doesn't have a strcasestr() function. But you can add
|
|
3517 "\c" to the pattern to ignore case: >
|
|
3518 :let idx = match(haystack, '\cneedle')
|
|
3519 <
|
95
|
3520 If {start} is given, the search starts from byte index
|
685
|
3521 {start} in a String or item {start} in a |List|.
|
7
|
3522 The result, however, is still the index counted from the
|
236
|
3523 first character/item. Example: >
|
7
|
3524 :echo match("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3525 < result is again "4". >
|
|
3526 :echo match("testing", "ing", 4)
|
|
3527 < result is again "4". >
|
|
3528 :echo match("testing", "t", 2)
|
|
3529 < result is "3".
|
694
|
3530 For a String, if {start} > 0 then it is like the string starts
|
703
|
3531 {start} bytes later, thus "^" will match at {start}. Except
|
|
3532 when {count} is given, then it's like matches before the
|
|
3533 {start} byte are ignored (this is a bit complicated to keep it
|
|
3534 backwards compatible).
|
95
|
3535 For a String, if {start} < 0, it will be set to 0. For a list
|
|
3536 the index is counted from the end.
|
697
|
3537 If {start} is out of range ({start} > strlen({expr}) for a
|
|
3538 String or {start} > len({expr}) for a |List|) -1 is returned.
|
95
|
3539
|
694
|
3540 When {count} is given use the {count}'th match. When a match
|
697
|
3541 is found in a String the search for the next one starts one
|
694
|
3542 character further. Thus this example results in 1: >
|
|
3543 echo match("testing", "..", 0, 2)
|
|
3544 < In a |List| the search continues in the next item.
|
703
|
3545 Note that when {count} is added the way {start} works changes,
|
|
3546 see above.
|
694
|
3547
|
7
|
3548 See |pattern| for the patterns that are accepted.
|
|
3549 The 'ignorecase' option is used to set the ignore-caseness of
|
|
3550 the pattern. 'smartcase' is NOT used. The matching is always
|
|
3551 done like 'magic' is set and 'cpoptions' is empty.
|
|
3552
|
819
|
3553
|
|
3554 matcharg({nr}) *matcharg()*
|
856
|
3555 Selects the {nr} match item, as set with a |:match|,
|
819
|
3556 |:2match| or |:3match| command.
|
|
3557 Return a |List| with two elements:
|
|
3558 The name of the highlight group used
|
|
3559 The pattern used.
|
|
3560 When {nr} is not 1, 2 or 3 returns an empty |List|.
|
|
3561 When there is no match item set returns ['', ''].
|
|
3562 This is usef to save and restore a |:match|.
|
|
3563
|
|
3564
|
19
|
3565 matchend({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchend()*
|
7
|
3566 Same as match(), but return the index of first character after
|
|
3567 the match. Example: >
|
|
3568 :echo matchend("testing", "ing")
|
|
3569 < results in "7".
|
170
|
3570 *strspn()* *strcspn()*
|
|
3571 Vim doesn't have a strspn() or strcspn() function, but you can
|
|
3572 do it with matchend(): >
|
|
3573 :let span = matchend(line, '[a-zA-Z]')
|
|
3574 :let span = matchend(line, '[^a-zA-Z]')
|
|
3575 < Except that -1 is returned when there are no matches.
|
|
3576
|
7
|
3577 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
|
|
3578 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3579 < results in "7". >
|
|
3580 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 5)
|
|
3581 < result is "-1".
|
685
|
3582 When {expr} is a |List| the result is equal to match().
|
7
|
3583
|
158
|
3584 matchlist({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchlist()*
|
685
|
3585 Same as match(), but return a |List|. The first item in the
|
158
|
3586 list is the matched string, same as what matchstr() would
|
|
3587 return. Following items are submatches, like "\1", "\2", etc.
|
842
|
3588 in |:substitute|. When an optional submatch didn't match an
|
|
3589 empty string is used. Example: >
|
|
3590 echo matchlist('acd', '\(a\)\?\(b\)\?\(c\)\?\(.*\)')
|
|
3591 < Results in: ['acd', 'a', '', 'c', 'd', '', '', '', '', '']
|
158
|
3592 When there is no match an empty list is returned.
|
|
3593
|
19
|
3594 matchstr({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchstr()*
|
7
|
3595 Same as match(), but return the matched string. Example: >
|
|
3596 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing")
|
|
3597 < results in "ing".
|
|
3598 When there is no match "" is returned.
|
|
3599 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
|
|
3600 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 2)
|
|
3601 < results in "ing". >
|
|
3602 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 5)
|
|
3603 < result is "".
|
685
|
3604 When {expr} is a |List| then the matching item is returned.
|
95
|
3605 The type isn't changed, it's not necessarily a String.
|
7
|
3606
|
87
|
3607 *max()*
|
|
3608 max({list}) Return the maximum value of all items in {list}.
|
|
3609 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
|
|
3610 be used as a Number this results in an error.
|
685
|
3611 An empty |List| results in zero.
|
87
|
3612
|
|
3613 *min()*
|
|
3614 min({list}) Return the minumum value of all items in {list}.
|
|
3615 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
|
|
3616 be used as a Number this results in an error.
|
685
|
3617 An empty |List| results in zero.
|
87
|
3618
|
843
|
3619 *mkdir()* *E739*
|
168
|
3620 mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
|
|
3621 Create directory {name}.
|
|
3622 If {path} is "p" then intermediate directories are created as
|
|
3623 necessary. Otherwise it must be "".
|
|
3624 If {prot} is given it is used to set the protection bits of
|
|
3625 the new directory. The default is 0755 (rwxr-xr-x: r/w for
|
|
3626 the user readable for others). Use 0700 to make it unreadable
|
|
3627 for others.
|
|
3628 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3629 Not available on all systems. To check use: >
|
|
3630 :if exists("*mkdir")
|
|
3631 <
|
7
|
3632 *mode()*
|
|
3633 mode() Return a string that indicates the current mode:
|
|
3634 n Normal
|
|
3635 v Visual by character
|
|
3636 V Visual by line
|
|
3637 CTRL-V Visual blockwise
|
|
3638 s Select by character
|
|
3639 S Select by line
|
|
3640 CTRL-S Select blockwise
|
|
3641 i Insert
|
|
3642 R Replace
|
|
3643 c Command-line
|
|
3644 r Hit-enter prompt
|
|
3645 This is useful in the 'statusline' option. In most other
|
|
3646 places it always returns "c" or "n".
|
|
3647
|
|
3648 nextnonblank({lnum}) *nextnonblank()*
|
|
3649 Return the line number of the first line at or below {lnum}
|
|
3650 that is not blank. Example: >
|
|
3651 if getline(nextnonblank(1)) =~ "Java"
|
|
3652 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
|
|
3653 below it, zero is returned.
|
|
3654 See also |prevnonblank()|.
|
|
3655
|
|
3656 nr2char({expr}) *nr2char()*
|
|
3657 Return a string with a single character, which has the number
|
|
3658 value {expr}. Examples: >
|
|
3659 nr2char(64) returns "@"
|
|
3660 nr2char(32) returns " "
|
|
3661 < The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
|
|
3662 nr2char(300) returns I with bow character
|
|
3663 < Note that a NUL character in the file is specified with
|
|
3664 nr2char(10), because NULs are represented with newline
|
|
3665 characters. nr2char(0) is a real NUL and terminates the
|
119
|
3666 string, thus results in an empty string.
|
7
|
3667
|
703
|
3668 *getpos()*
|
707
|
3669 getpos({expr}) Get the position for {expr}. For possible values of {expr}
|
|
3670 see |line()|.
|
|
3671 The result is a |List| with four numbers:
|
|
3672 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
|
|
3673 "bufnum" is zero, unless a mark like '0 or 'A is used, then it
|
|
3674 is the buffer number of the mark.
|
|
3675 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
|
|
3676 column is 1.
|
703
|
3677 The "off" number is zero, unless 'virtualedit' is used. Then
|
|
3678 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
3679 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
3680 character.
|
|
3681 This can be used to save and restore the cursor position: >
|
|
3682 let save_cursor = getpos(".")
|
|
3683 MoveTheCursorAround
|
798
|
3684 call setpos('.', save_cursor)
|
707
|
3685 < Also see |setpos()|.
|
703
|
3686
|
819
|
3687 pathshorten({expr}) *pathshorten()*
|
|
3688 Shorten directory names in the path {expr} and return the
|
|
3689 result. The tail, the file name, is kept as-is. The other
|
|
3690 components in the path are reduced to single letters. Leading
|
|
3691 '~' and '.' characters are kept. Example: >
|
|
3692 :echo pathshorten('~/.vim/autoload/myfile.vim')
|
|
3693 < ~/.v/a/myfile.vim ~
|
|
3694 It doesn't matter if the path exists or not.
|
|
3695
|
667
|
3696 prevnonblank({lnum}) *prevnonblank()*
|
|
3697 Return the line number of the first line at or above {lnum}
|
|
3698 that is not blank. Example: >
|
|
3699 let ind = indent(prevnonblank(v:lnum - 1))
|
|
3700 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
|
|
3701 above it, zero is returned.
|
|
3702 Also see |nextnonblank()|.
|
|
3703
|
|
3704
|
449
|
3705 printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()*
|
|
3706 Return a String with {fmt}, where "%" items are replaced by
|
|
3707 the formatted form of their respective arguments. Example: >
|
452
|
3708 printf("%4d: E%d %.30s", lnum, errno, msg)
|
449
|
3709 < May result in:
|
452
|
3710 " 99: E42 asdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfas" ~
|
449
|
3711
|
|
3712 Often used items are:
|
856
|
3713 %s string
|
653
|
3714 %6s string right-aligned in 6 bytes
|
|
3715 %.9s string truncated to 9 bytes
|
452
|
3716 %c single byte
|
449
|
3717 %d decimal number
|
|
3718 %5d decimal number padded with spaces to 5 characters
|
|
3719 %x hex number
|
|
3720 %04x hex number padded with zeros to at least 4 characters
|
|
3721 %X hex number using upper case letters
|
|
3722 %o octal number
|
653
|
3723 %% the % character itself
|
449
|
3724
|
|
3725 Conversion specifications start with '%' and end with the
|
|
3726 conversion type. All other characters are copied unchanged to
|
|
3727 the result.
|
|
3728
|
|
3729 The "%" starts a conversion specification. The following
|
452
|
3730 arguments appear in sequence:
|
|
3731
|
|
3732 % [flags] [field-width] [.precision] type
|
|
3733
|
856
|
3734 flags
|
452
|
3735 Zero or more of the following flags:
|
|
3736
|
449
|
3737 # The value should be converted to an "alternate
|
|
3738 form". For c, d, and s conversions, this option
|
|
3739 has no effect. For o conversions, the precision
|
|
3740 of the number is increased to force the first
|
|
3741 character of the output string to a zero (except
|
|
3742 if a zero value is printed with an explicit
|
|
3743 precision of zero).
|
|
3744 For x and X conversions, a non-zero result has
|
|
3745 the string "0x" (or "0X" for X conversions)
|
|
3746 prepended to it.
|
452
|
3747
|
449
|
3748 0 (zero) Zero padding. For all conversions the converted
|
|
3749 value is padded on the left with zeros rather
|
|
3750 than blanks. If a precision is given with a
|
|
3751 numeric conversion (d, o, x, and X), the 0 flag
|
|
3752 is ignored.
|
452
|
3753
|
449
|
3754 - A negative field width flag; the converted value
|
|
3755 is to be left adjusted on the field boundary.
|
|
3756 The converted value is padded on the right with
|
|
3757 blanks, rather than on the left with blanks or
|
|
3758 zeros. A - overrides a 0 if both are given.
|
452
|
3759
|
449
|
3760 ' ' (space) A blank should be left before a positive
|
|
3761 number produced by a signed conversion (d).
|
452
|
3762
|
449
|
3763 + A sign must always be placed before a number
|
|
3764 produced by a signed conversion. A + overrides
|
|
3765 a space if both are used.
|
452
|
3766
|
|
3767 field-width
|
|
3768 An optional decimal digit string specifying a minimum
|
653
|
3769 field width. If the converted value has fewer bytes
|
|
3770 than the field width, it will be padded with spaces on
|
|
3771 the left (or right, if the left-adjustment flag has
|
|
3772 been given) to fill out the field width.
|
452
|
3773
|
|
3774 .precision
|
|
3775 An optional precision, in the form of a period '.'
|
|
3776 followed by an optional digit string. If the digit
|
|
3777 string is omitted, the precision is taken as zero.
|
|
3778 This gives the minimum number of digits to appear for
|
|
3779 d, o, x, and X conversions, or the maximum number of
|
653
|
3780 bytes to be printed from a string for s conversions.
|
452
|
3781
|
|
3782 type
|
|
3783 A character that specifies the type of conversion to
|
|
3784 be applied, see below.
|
|
3785
|
449
|
3786 A field width or precision, or both, may be indicated by an
|
|
3787 asterisk '*' instead of a digit string. In this case, a
|
|
3788 Number argument supplies the field width or precision. A
|
|
3789 negative field width is treated as a left adjustment flag
|
|
3790 followed by a positive field width; a negative precision is
|
|
3791 treated as though it were missing. Example: >
|
452
|
3792 :echo printf("%d: %.*s", nr, width, line)
|
449
|
3793 < This limits the length of the text used from "line" to
|
452
|
3794 "width" bytes.
|
449
|
3795
|
856
|
3796 The conversion specifiers and their meanings are:
|
452
|
3797
|
449
|
3798 doxX The Number argument is converted to signed decimal
|
|
3799 (d), unsigned octal (o), or unsigned hexadecimal (x
|
|
3800 and X) notation. The letters "abcdef" are used for
|
|
3801 x conversions; the letters "ABCDEF" are used for X
|
452
|
3802 conversions.
|
|
3803 The precision, if any, gives the minimum number of
|
|
3804 digits that must appear; if the converted value
|
|
3805 requires fewer digits, it is padded on the left with
|
|
3806 zeros.
|
|
3807 In no case does a non-existent or small field width
|
|
3808 cause truncation of a numeric field; if the result of
|
|
3809 a conversion is wider than the field width, the field
|
|
3810 is expanded to contain the conversion result.
|
|
3811
|
|
3812 c The Number argument is converted to a byte, and the
|
|
3813 resulting character is written.
|
|
3814
|
|
3815 s The text of the String argument is used. If a
|
|
3816 precision is specified, no more bytes than the number
|
|
3817 specified are used.
|
|
3818
|
449
|
3819 % A '%' is written. No argument is converted. The
|
|
3820 complete conversion specification is "%%".
|
452
|
3821
|
449
|
3822 Each argument can be Number or String and is converted
|
452
|
3823 automatically to fit the conversion specifier. Any other
|
|
3824 argument type results in an error message.
|
449
|
3825
|
459
|
3826 *E766* *E767*
|
449
|
3827 The number of {exprN} arguments must exactly match the number
|
|
3828 of "%" items. If there are not sufficient or too many
|
452
|
3829 arguments an error is given. Up to 18 arguments can be used.
|
449
|
3830
|
|
3831
|
667
|
3832 pumvisible() *pumvisible()*
|
|
3833 Returns non-zero when the popup menu is visible, zero
|
|
3834 otherwise. See |ins-completion-menu|.
|
712
|
3835 This can be used to avoid some things that would remove the
|
|
3836 popup menu.
|
7
|
3837
|
114
|
3838 *E726* *E727*
|
99
|
3839 range({expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) *range()*
|
685
|
3840 Returns a |List| with Numbers:
|
99
|
3841 - If only {expr} is specified: [0, 1, ..., {expr} - 1]
|
|
3842 - If {max} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + 1, ..., {max}]
|
|
3843 - If {stride} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + {stride}, ...,
|
|
3844 {max}] (increasing {expr} with {stride} each time, not
|
|
3845 producing a value past {max}).
|
336
|
3846 When the maximum is one before the start the result is an
|
|
3847 empty list. When the maximum is more than one before the
|
|
3848 start this is an error.
|
99
|
3849 Examples: >
|
856
|
3850 range(4) " [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
99
|
3851 range(2, 4) " [2, 3, 4]
|
|
3852 range(2, 9, 3) " [2, 5, 8]
|
856
|
3853 range(2, -2, -1) " [2, 1, 0, -1, -2]
|
336
|
3854 range(0) " []
|
|
3855 range(2, 0) " error!
|
99
|
3856 <
|
158
|
3857 *readfile()*
|
168
|
3858 readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
|
685
|
3859 Read file {fname} and return a |List|, each line of the file
|
|
3860 as an item. Lines broken at NL characters. Macintosh files
|
158
|
3861 separated with CR will result in a single long line (unless a
|
|
3862 NL appears somewhere).
|
|
3863 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used:
|
|
3864 - When the last line ends in a NL an extra empty list item is
|
|
3865 added.
|
|
3866 - No CR characters are removed.
|
|
3867 Otherwise:
|
|
3868 - CR characters that appear before a NL are removed.
|
|
3869 - Whether the last line ends in a NL or not does not matter.
|
|
3870 All NUL characters are replaced with a NL character.
|
168
|
3871 When {max} is given this specifies the maximum number of lines
|
|
3872 to be read. Useful if you only want to check the first ten
|
|
3873 lines of a file: >
|
|
3874 :for line in readfile(fname, '', 10)
|
|
3875 : if line =~ 'Date' | echo line | endif
|
|
3876 :endfor
|
233
|
3877 < When {max} is negative -{max} lines from the end of the file
|
|
3878 are returned, or as many as there are.
|
|
3879 When {max} is zero the result is an empty list.
|
168
|
3880 Note that without {max} the whole file is read into memory.
|
|
3881 Also note that there is no recognition of encoding. Read a
|
|
3882 file into a buffer if you need to.
|
158
|
3883 When the file can't be opened an error message is given and
|
|
3884 the result is an empty list.
|
|
3885 Also see |writefile()|.
|
|
3886
|
794
|
3887 reltime([{start} [, {end}]]) *reltime()*
|
|
3888 Return an item that represents a time value. The format of
|
|
3889 the item depends on the system. It can be passed to
|
|
3890 |reltimestr()| to convert it to a string.
|
|
3891 Without an argument it returns the current time.
|
|
3892 With one argument is returns the time passed since the time
|
|
3893 specified in the argument.
|
843
|
3894 With two arguments it returns the time passed between {start}
|
794
|
3895 and {end}.
|
|
3896 The {start} and {end} arguments must be values returned by
|
|
3897 reltime().
|
|
3898 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
|
|
3899
|
|
3900 reltimestr({time}) *reltimestr()*
|
|
3901 Return a String that represents the time value of {time}.
|
|
3902 This is the number of seconds, a dot and the number of
|
|
3903 microseconds. Example: >
|
|
3904 let start = reltime()
|
|
3905 call MyFunction()
|
|
3906 echo reltimestr(reltime(start))
|
|
3907 < Note that overhead for the commands will be added to the time.
|
|
3908 The accuracy depends on the system.
|
|
3909 Also see |profiling|.
|
|
3910 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
|
|
3911
|
7
|
3912 *remote_expr()* *E449*
|
|
3913 remote_expr({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
|
3914 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as an
|
|
3915 expression and the result is returned after evaluation.
|
714
|
3916 The result must be a String or a |List|. A |List| is turned
|
|
3917 into a String by joining the items with a line break in
|
|
3918 between (not at the end), like with join(expr, "\n").
|
7
|
3919 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a
|
|
3920 variable and a {serverid} for later use with
|
|
3921 remote_read() is stored there.
|
|
3922 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
|
|
3923 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3924 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3925 Note: Any errors will cause a local error message to be issued
|
|
3926 and the result will be the empty string.
|
|
3927 Examples: >
|
|
3928 :echo remote_expr("gvim", "2+2")
|
|
3929 :echo remote_expr("gvim1", "b:current_syntax")
|
|
3930 <
|
|
3931
|
|
3932 remote_foreground({server}) *remote_foreground()*
|
|
3933 Move the Vim server with the name {server} to the foreground.
|
|
3934 This works like: >
|
|
3935 remote_expr({server}, "foreground()")
|
|
3936 < Except that on Win32 systems the client does the work, to work
|
|
3937 around the problem that the OS doesn't always allow the server
|
|
3938 to bring itself to the foreground.
|
574
|
3939 Note: This does not restore the window if it was minimized,
|
|
3940 like foreground() does.
|
7
|
3941 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3942 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
|
|
3943 Win32 console version}
|
|
3944
|
|
3945
|
|
3946 remote_peek({serverid} [, {retvar}]) *remote_peek()*
|
|
3947 Returns a positive number if there are available strings
|
|
3948 from {serverid}. Copies any reply string into the variable
|
|
3949 {retvar} if specified. {retvar} must be a string with the
|
|
3950 name of a variable.
|
|
3951 Returns zero if none are available.
|
|
3952 Returns -1 if something is wrong.
|
|
3953 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
3954 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3955 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3956 Examples: >
|
|
3957 :let repl = ""
|
|
3958 :echo "PEEK: ".remote_peek(id, "repl").": ".repl
|
|
3959
|
|
3960 remote_read({serverid}) *remote_read()*
|
|
3961 Return the oldest available reply from {serverid} and consume
|
|
3962 it. It blocks until a reply is available.
|
|
3963 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
3964 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3965 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3966 Example: >
|
|
3967 :echo remote_read(id)
|
|
3968 <
|
|
3969 *remote_send()* *E241*
|
|
3970 remote_send({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
|
22
|
3971 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as input
|
|
3972 keys and the function returns immediately. At the Vim server
|
|
3973 the keys are not mapped |:map|.
|
667
|
3974 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a variable
|
|
3975 and a {serverid} for later use with remote_read() is stored
|
|
3976 there.
|
7
|
3977 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
|
|
3978 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
3979 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
3980 Note: Any errors will be reported in the server and may mess
|
|
3981 up the display.
|
|
3982 Examples: >
|
|
3983 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":DropAndReply ".file, "serverid").
|
|
3984 \ remote_read(serverid)
|
|
3985
|
|
3986 :autocmd NONE RemoteReply *
|
|
3987 \ echo remote_read(expand("<amatch>"))
|
|
3988 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":sleep 10 | echo ".
|
|
3989 \ 'server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")<CR>')
|
82
|
3990 <
|
79
|
3991 remove({list}, {idx} [, {end}]) *remove()*
|
685
|
3992 Without {end}: Remove the item at {idx} from |List| {list} and
|
79
|
3993 return it.
|
|
3994 With {end}: Remove items from {idx} to {end} (inclusive) and
|
|
3995 return a list with these items. When {idx} points to the same
|
|
3996 item as {end} a list with one item is returned. When {end}
|
|
3997 points to an item before {idx} this is an error.
|
|
3998 See |list-index| for possible values of {idx} and {end}.
|
55
|
3999 Example: >
|
|
4000 :echo "last item: " . remove(mylist, -1)
|
79
|
4001 :call remove(mylist, 0, 9)
|
99
|
4002 remove({dict}, {key})
|
|
4003 Remove the entry from {dict} with key {key}. Example: >
|
|
4004 :echo "removed " . remove(dict, "one")
|
|
4005 < If there is no {key} in {dict} this is an error.
|
|
4006
|
|
4007 Use |delete()| to remove a file.
|
55
|
4008
|
7
|
4009 rename({from}, {to}) *rename()*
|
|
4010 Rename the file by the name {from} to the name {to}. This
|
|
4011 should also work to move files across file systems. The
|
|
4012 result is a Number, which is 0 if the file was renamed
|
|
4013 successfully, and non-zero when the renaming failed.
|
|
4014 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
4015
|
18
|
4016 repeat({expr}, {count}) *repeat()*
|
|
4017 Repeat {expr} {count} times and return the concatenated
|
|
4018 result. Example: >
|
843
|
4019 :let separator = repeat('-', 80)
|
18
|
4020 < When {count} is zero or negative the result is empty.
|
685
|
4021 When {expr} is a |List| the result is {expr} concatenated
|
236
|
4022 {count} times. Example: >
|
79
|
4023 :let longlist = repeat(['a', 'b'], 3)
|
|
4024 < Results in ['a', 'b', 'a', 'b', 'a', 'b'].
|
18
|
4025
|
82
|
4026
|
7
|
4027 resolve({filename}) *resolve()* *E655*
|
|
4028 On MS-Windows, when {filename} is a shortcut (a .lnk file),
|
|
4029 returns the path the shortcut points to in a simplified form.
|
|
4030 On Unix, repeat resolving symbolic links in all path
|
|
4031 components of {filename} and return the simplified result.
|
|
4032 To cope with link cycles, resolving of symbolic links is
|
|
4033 stopped after 100 iterations.
|
|
4034 On other systems, return the simplified {filename}.
|
|
4035 The simplification step is done as by |simplify()|.
|
|
4036 resolve() keeps a leading path component specifying the
|
|
4037 current directory (provided the result is still a relative
|
|
4038 path name) and also keeps a trailing path separator.
|
|
4039
|
82
|
4040 *reverse()*
|
|
4041 reverse({list}) Reverse the order of items in {list} in-place. Returns
|
|
4042 {list}.
|
|
4043 If you want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
|
4044 :let revlist = reverse(copy(mylist))
|
|
4045
|
692
|
4046 search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]]) *search()*
|
7
|
4047 Search for regexp pattern {pattern}. The search starts at the
|
119
|
4048 cursor position (you can use |cursor()| to set it).
|
707
|
4049
|
7
|
4050 {flags} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
|
|
4051 'b' search backward instead of forward
|
712
|
4052 'c' accept a match at the cursor position
|
|
4053 'e' move to the End of the match
|
20
|
4054 'n' do Not move the cursor
|
712
|
4055 'p' return number of matching sub-pattern (see below)
|
|
4056 's' set the ' mark at the previous location of the cursor
|
7
|
4057 'w' wrap around the end of the file
|
|
4058 'W' don't wrap around the end of the file
|
|
4059 If neither 'w' or 'W' is given, the 'wrapscan' option applies.
|
|
4060
|
444
|
4061 If the 's' flag is supplied, the ' mark is set, only if the
|
|
4062 cursor is moved. The 's' flag cannot be combined with the 'n'
|
|
4063 flag.
|
|
4064
|
692
|
4065 When the {stopline} argument is given then the search stops
|
|
4066 after searching this line. This is useful to restrict the
|
|
4067 search to a range of lines. Examples: >
|
|
4068 let match = search('(', 'b', line("w0"))
|
|
4069 let end = search('END', '', line("w$"))
|
|
4070 < When {stopline} is used and it is not zero this also implies
|
|
4071 that the search does not wrap around the end of the file.
|
|
4072
|
712
|
4073 If there is no match a 0 is returned and the cursor doesn't
|
|
4074 move. No error message is given.
|
714
|
4075 When a match has been found its line number is returned.
|
|
4076 *search()-sub-match*
|
|
4077 With the 'p' flag the returned value is one more than the
|
|
4078 first sub-match in \(\). One if none of them matched but the
|
|
4079 whole pattern did match.
|
712
|
4080 To get the column number too use |searchpos()|.
|
|
4081
|
20
|
4082 The cursor will be positioned at the match, unless the 'n'
|
707
|
4083 flag is used.
|
7
|
4084
|
|
4085 Example (goes over all files in the argument list): >
|
|
4086 :let n = 1
|
|
4087 :while n <= argc() " loop over all files in arglist
|
|
4088 : exe "argument " . n
|
|
4089 : " start at the last char in the file and wrap for the
|
|
4090 : " first search to find match at start of file
|
|
4091 : normal G$
|
|
4092 : let flags = "w"
|
|
4093 : while search("foo", flags) > 0
|
|
4094 : s/foo/bar/g
|
|
4095 : let flags = "W"
|
|
4096 : endwhile
|
|
4097 : update " write the file if modified
|
|
4098 : let n = n + 1
|
|
4099 :endwhile
|
|
4100 <
|
712
|
4101 Example for using some flags: >
|
|
4102 :echo search('\<if\|\(else\)\|\(endif\)', 'ncpe')
|
|
4103 < This will search for the keywords "if", "else", and "endif"
|
|
4104 under or after the cursor. Because of the 'p' flag, it
|
|
4105 returns 1, 2, or 3 depending on which keyword is found, or 0
|
|
4106 if the search fails. With the cursor on the first word of the
|
|
4107 line:
|
|
4108 if (foo == 0) | let foo = foo + 1 | endif ~
|
|
4109 the function returns 1. Without the 'c' flag, the function
|
|
4110 finds the "endif" and returns 3. The same thing happens
|
|
4111 without the 'e' flag if the cursor is on the "f" of "if".
|
|
4112 The 'n' flag tells the function not to move the cursor.
|
|
4113
|
504
|
4114
|
523
|
4115 searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]]) *searchdecl()*
|
|
4116 Search for the declaration of {name}.
|
856
|
4117
|
523
|
4118 With a non-zero {global} argument it works like |gD|, find
|
|
4119 first match in the file. Otherwise it works like |gd|, find
|
|
4120 first match in the function.
|
|
4121
|
|
4122 With a non-zero {thisblock} argument matches in a {} block
|
|
4123 that ends before the cursor position are ignored. Avoids
|
|
4124 finding variable declarations only valid in another scope.
|
|
4125
|
504
|
4126 Moves the cursor to the found match.
|
|
4127 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
|
4128 Example: >
|
|
4129 if searchdecl('myvar') == 0
|
|
4130 echo getline('.')
|
|
4131 endif
|
|
4132 <
|
7
|
4133 *searchpair()*
|
692
|
4134 searchpair({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
7
|
4135 Search for the match of a nested start-end pair. This can be
|
|
4136 used to find the "endif" that matches an "if", while other
|
|
4137 if/endif pairs in between are ignored.
|
677
|
4138 The search starts at the cursor. The default is to search
|
|
4139 forward, include 'b' in {flags} to search backward.
|
|
4140 If a match is found, the cursor is positioned at it and the
|
|
4141 line number is returned. If no match is found 0 or -1 is
|
|
4142 returned and the cursor doesn't move. No error message is
|
|
4143 given.
|
7
|
4144
|
|
4145 {start}, {middle} and {end} are patterns, see |pattern|. They
|
|
4146 must not contain \( \) pairs. Use of \%( \) is allowed. When
|
|
4147 {middle} is not empty, it is found when searching from either
|
|
4148 direction, but only when not in a nested start-end pair. A
|
|
4149 typical use is: >
|
|
4150 searchpair('\<if\>', '\<else\>', '\<endif\>')
|
|
4151 < By leaving {middle} empty the "else" is skipped.
|
|
4152
|
712
|
4153 {flags} 'b', 'c', 'n', 's', 'w' and 'W' are used like with
|
|
4154 |search()|. Additionally:
|
7
|
4155 'r' Repeat until no more matches found; will find the
|
|
4156 outer pair
|
|
4157 'm' return number of Matches instead of line number with
|
712
|
4158 the match; will be > 1 when 'r' is used.
|
7
|
4159
|
|
4160 When a match for {start}, {middle} or {end} is found, the
|
|
4161 {skip} expression is evaluated with the cursor positioned on
|
|
4162 the start of the match. It should return non-zero if this
|
|
4163 match is to be skipped. E.g., because it is inside a comment
|
|
4164 or a string.
|
|
4165 When {skip} is omitted or empty, every match is accepted.
|
|
4166 When evaluating {skip} causes an error the search is aborted
|
|
4167 and -1 returned.
|
|
4168
|
692
|
4169 For {stopline} see |search()|.
|
|
4170
|
7
|
4171 The value of 'ignorecase' is used. 'magic' is ignored, the
|
|
4172 patterns are used like it's on.
|
|
4173
|
|
4174 The search starts exactly at the cursor. A match with
|
|
4175 {start}, {middle} or {end} at the next character, in the
|
|
4176 direction of searching, is the first one found. Example: >
|
|
4177 if 1
|
|
4178 if 2
|
|
4179 endif 2
|
|
4180 endif 1
|
|
4181 < When starting at the "if 2", with the cursor on the "i", and
|
|
4182 searching forwards, the "endif 2" is found. When starting on
|
|
4183 the character just before the "if 2", the "endif 1" will be
|
|
4184 found. That's because the "if 2" will be found first, and
|
|
4185 then this is considered to be a nested if/endif from "if 2" to
|
|
4186 "endif 2".
|
|
4187 When searching backwards and {end} is more than one character,
|
|
4188 it may be useful to put "\zs" at the end of the pattern, so
|
|
4189 that when the cursor is inside a match with the end it finds
|
|
4190 the matching start.
|
|
4191
|
|
4192 Example, to find the "endif" command in a Vim script: >
|
|
4193
|
|
4194 :echo searchpair('\<if\>', '\<el\%[seif]\>', '\<en\%[dif]\>', 'W',
|
|
4195 \ 'getline(".") =~ "^\\s*\""')
|
|
4196
|
|
4197 < The cursor must be at or after the "if" for which a match is
|
|
4198 to be found. Note that single-quote strings are used to avoid
|
|
4199 having to double the backslashes. The skip expression only
|
|
4200 catches comments at the start of a line, not after a command.
|
|
4201 Also, a word "en" or "if" halfway a line is considered a
|
|
4202 match.
|
|
4203 Another example, to search for the matching "{" of a "}": >
|
|
4204
|
|
4205 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW')
|
|
4206
|
|
4207 < This works when the cursor is at or before the "}" for which a
|
|
4208 match is to be found. To reject matches that syntax
|
|
4209 highlighting recognized as strings: >
|
|
4210
|
|
4211 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW',
|
|
4212 \ 'synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 0), "name") =~? "string"')
|
|
4213 <
|
667
|
4214 *searchpairpos()*
|
692
|
4215 searchpairpos({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [, {stopline}]]])
|
685
|
4216 Same as searchpair(), but returns a |List| with the line and
|
|
4217 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
|
|
4218 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
|
667
|
4219 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
|
|
4220 returns [0, 0].
|
|
4221 >
|
|
4222 :let [lnum,col] = searchpairpos('{', '', '}', 'n')
|
|
4223 <
|
|
4224 See |match-parens| for a bigger and more useful example.
|
|
4225
|
692
|
4226 searchpos({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline}]]) *searchpos()*
|
|
4227 Same as |search()|, but returns a |List| with the line and
|
685
|
4228 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
|
|
4229 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
|
|
4230 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
|
|
4231 returns [0, 0].
|
714
|
4232 Example: >
|
|
4233 :let [lnum, col] = searchpos('mypattern', 'n')
|
|
4234
|
|
4235 < When the 'p' flag is given then there is an extra item with
|
|
4236 the sub-pattern match number |search()-sub-match|. Example: >
|
|
4237 :let [lnum, col, submatch] = searchpos('\(\l\)\|\(\u\)', 'np')
|
|
4238 < In this example "submatch" is 2 when a lowercase letter is
|
|
4239 found |/\l|, 3 when an uppercase letter is found |/\u|.
|
|
4240
|
7
|
4241 server2client( {clientid}, {string}) *server2client()*
|
|
4242 Send a reply string to {clientid}. The most recent {clientid}
|
|
4243 that sent a string can be retrieved with expand("<client>").
|
|
4244 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
4245 Note:
|
|
4246 This id has to be stored before the next command can be
|
236
|
4247 received. I.e. before returning from the received command and
|
7
|
4248 before calling any commands that waits for input.
|
|
4249 See also |clientserver|.
|
|
4250 Example: >
|
|
4251 :echo server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")
|
|
4252 <
|
|
4253 serverlist() *serverlist()*
|
|
4254 Return a list of available server names, one per line.
|
|
4255 When there are no servers or the information is not available
|
|
4256 an empty string is returned. See also |clientserver|.
|
|
4257 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
|
|
4258 Example: >
|
|
4259 :echo serverlist()
|
|
4260 <
|
|
4261 setbufvar({expr}, {varname}, {val}) *setbufvar()*
|
|
4262 Set option or local variable {varname} in buffer {expr} to
|
|
4263 {val}.
|
|
4264 This also works for a global or local window option, but it
|
|
4265 doesn't work for a global or local window variable.
|
|
4266 For a local window option the global value is unchanged.
|
|
4267 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
|
|
4268 Note that the variable name without "b:" must be used.
|
|
4269 Examples: >
|
|
4270 :call setbufvar(1, "&mod", 1)
|
|
4271 :call setbufvar("todo", "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4272 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
4273
|
|
4274 setcmdpos({pos}) *setcmdpos()*
|
|
4275 Set the cursor position in the command line to byte position
|
|
4276 {pos}. The first position is 1.
|
|
4277 Use |getcmdpos()| to obtain the current position.
|
|
4278 Only works while editing the command line, thus you must use
|
99
|
4279 |c_CTRL-\_e|, |c_CTRL-R_=| or |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '='. For
|
|
4280 |c_CTRL-\_e| and |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '=' the position is
|
|
4281 set after the command line is set to the expression. For
|
|
4282 |c_CTRL-R_=| it is set after evaluating the expression but
|
|
4283 before inserting the resulting text.
|
7
|
4284 When the number is too big the cursor is put at the end of the
|
|
4285 line. A number smaller than one has undefined results.
|
|
4286 Returns 0 when successful, 1 when not editing the command
|
|
4287 line.
|
|
4288
|
|
4289 setline({lnum}, {line}) *setline()*
|
236
|
4290 Set line {lnum} of the current buffer to {line}.
|
|
4291 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|.
|
282
|
4292 When {lnum} is just below the last line the {line} will be
|
|
4293 added as a new line.
|
236
|
4294 If this succeeds, 0 is returned. If this fails (most likely
|
|
4295 because {lnum} is invalid) 1 is returned. Example: >
|
7
|
4296 :call setline(5, strftime("%c"))
|
685
|
4297 < When {line} is a |List| then line {lnum} and following lines
|
282
|
4298 will be set to the items in the list. Example: >
|
|
4299 :call setline(5, ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc'])
|
|
4300 < This is equivalent to: >
|
|
4301 :for [n, l] in [[5, 6, 7], ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc']]
|
|
4302 : call setline(n, l)
|
|
4303 :endfor
|
7
|
4304 < Note: The '[ and '] marks are not set.
|
|
4305
|
647
|
4306 setloclist({nr}, {list} [, {action}]) *setloclist()*
|
|
4307 Create or replace or add to the location list for window {nr}.
|
|
4308 When {nr} is zero the current window is used. For a location
|
648
|
4309 list window, the displayed location list is modified. For an
|
|
4310 invalid window number {nr}, -1 is returned.
|
647
|
4311 Otherwise, same as setqflist().
|
230
|
4312
|
707
|
4313 *setpos()*
|
|
4314 setpos({expr}, {list})
|
|
4315 Set the position for {expr}. Possible values:
|
|
4316 . the cursor
|
|
4317 'x mark x
|
|
4318
|
|
4319 {list} must be a |List| with four numbers:
|
|
4320 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
|
|
4321
|
|
4322 "bufnum" is the buffer number. Zero can be used for the
|
856
|
4323 current buffer. Setting the cursor is only possible for
|
707
|
4324 the current buffer. To set a mark in another buffer you can
|
|
4325 use the |bufnr()| function to turn a file name into a buffer
|
|
4326 number.
|
798
|
4327 Does not change the jumplist.
|
707
|
4328
|
|
4329 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
|
|
4330 column is 1. Use a zero "lnum" to delete a mark.
|
|
4331
|
|
4332 The "off" number is only used when 'virtualedit' is set. Then
|
|
4333 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
4334 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
4335 character.
|
|
4336
|
|
4337 Also see |getpos()|
|
|
4338
|
|
4339
|
277
|
4340 setqflist({list} [, {action}]) *setqflist()*
|
647
|
4341 Create or replace or add to the quickfix list using the items
|
|
4342 in {list}. Each item in {list} is a dictionary.
|
|
4343 Non-dictionary items in {list} are ignored. Each dictionary
|
|
4344 item can contain the following entries:
|
230
|
4345
|
|
4346 filename name of a file
|
|
4347 lnum line number in the file
|
233
|
4348 pattern search pattern used to locate the error
|
230
|
4349 col column number
|
233
|
4350 vcol when non-zero: "col" is visual column
|
856
|
4351 when zero: "col" is byte index
|
233
|
4352 nr error number
|
230
|
4353 text description of the error
|
233
|
4354 type single-character error type, 'E', 'W', etc.
|
|
4355
|
|
4356 The "col", "vcol", "nr", "type" and "text" entries are
|
|
4357 optional. Either "lnum" or "pattern" entry can be used to
|
|
4358 locate a matching error line.
|
230
|
4359 If the "filename" entry is not present or neither the "lnum"
|
|
4360 or "pattern" entries are present, then the item will not be
|
|
4361 handled as an error line.
|
|
4362 If both "pattern" and "lnum" are present then "pattern" will
|
|
4363 be used.
|
|
4364
|
277
|
4365 If {action} is set to 'a', then the items from {list} are
|
|
4366 added to the existing quickfix list. If there is no existing
|
|
4367 list, then a new list is created. If {action} is set to 'r',
|
|
4368 then the items from the current quickfix list are replaced
|
|
4369 with the items from {list}. If {action} is not present or is
|
|
4370 set to ' ', then a new list is created.
|
|
4371
|
230
|
4372 Returns zero for success, -1 for failure.
|
|
4373
|
|
4374 This function can be used to create a quickfix list
|
|
4375 independent of the 'errorformat' setting. Use a command like
|
|
4376 ":cc 1" to jump to the first position.
|
|
4377
|
|
4378
|
7
|
4379 *setreg()*
|
|
4380 setreg({regname}, {value} [,{options}])
|
|
4381 Set the register {regname} to {value}.
|
|
4382 If {options} contains "a" or {regname} is upper case,
|
|
4383 then the value is appended.
|
|
4384 {options} can also contains a register type specification:
|
|
4385 "c" or "v" |characterwise| mode
|
|
4386 "l" or "V" |linewise| mode
|
|
4387 "b" or "<CTRL-V>" |blockwise-visual| mode
|
|
4388 If a number immediately follows "b" or "<CTRL-V>" then this is
|
|
4389 used as the width of the selection - if it is not specified
|
|
4390 then the width of the block is set to the number of characters
|
|
4391 in the longest line (counting a <TAB> as 1 character).
|
|
4392
|
|
4393 If {options} contains no register settings, then the default
|
|
4394 is to use character mode unless {value} ends in a <NL>.
|
|
4395 Setting the '=' register is not possible.
|
|
4396 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
|
4397
|
|
4398 Examples: >
|
|
4399 :call setreg(v:register, @*)
|
|
4400 :call setreg('*', @%, 'ac')
|
|
4401 :call setreg('a', "1\n2\n3", 'b5')
|
|
4402
|
|
4403 < This example shows using the functions to save and restore a
|
|
4404 register. >
|
282
|
4405 :let var_a = getreg('a', 1)
|
7
|
4406 :let var_amode = getregtype('a')
|
|
4407 ....
|
|
4408 :call setreg('a', var_a, var_amode)
|
|
4409
|
|
4410 < You can also change the type of a register by appending
|
|
4411 nothing: >
|
|
4412 :call setreg('a', '', 'al')
|
|
4413
|
831
|
4414 settabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) *settabwinvar()*
|
|
4415 Set option or local variable {varname} in window {winnr} to
|
|
4416 {val}.
|
|
4417 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
|
|
4418 use |setwinvar()|.
|
|
4419 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
|
7
|
4420 This also works for a global or local buffer option, but it
|
|
4421 doesn't work for a global or local buffer variable.
|
|
4422 For a local buffer option the global value is unchanged.
|
|
4423 Note that the variable name without "w:" must be used.
|
831
|
4424 Vim briefly goes to the tab page {tabnr}, this may trigger
|
|
4425 TabLeave and TabEnter autocommands.
|
|
4426 Examples: >
|
|
4427 :call settabwinvar(1, 1, "&list", 0)
|
|
4428 :call settabwinvar(3, 2, "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4429 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
|
|
4430
|
|
4431 setwinvar({nr}, {varname}, {val}) *setwinvar()*
|
|
4432 Like |settabwinvar()| for the current tab page.
|
7
|
4433 Examples: >
|
|
4434 :call setwinvar(1, "&list", 0)
|
|
4435 :call setwinvar(2, "myvar", "foobar")
|
|
4436
|
|
4437 simplify({filename}) *simplify()*
|
|
4438 Simplify the file name as much as possible without changing
|
|
4439 the meaning. Shortcuts (on MS-Windows) or symbolic links (on
|
|
4440 Unix) are not resolved. If the first path component in
|
|
4441 {filename} designates the current directory, this will be
|
|
4442 valid for the result as well. A trailing path separator is
|
|
4443 not removed either.
|
|
4444 Example: >
|
|
4445 simplify("./dir/.././/file/") == "./file/"
|
|
4446 < Note: The combination "dir/.." is only removed if "dir" is
|
|
4447 a searchable directory or does not exist. On Unix, it is also
|
|
4448 removed when "dir" is a symbolic link within the same
|
|
4449 directory. In order to resolve all the involved symbolic
|
|
4450 links before simplifying the path name, use |resolve()|.
|
|
4451
|
82
|
4452
|
85
|
4453 sort({list} [, {func}]) *sort()* *E702*
|
82
|
4454 Sort the items in {list} in-place. Returns {list}. If you
|
|
4455 want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
|
4456 :let sortedlist = sort(copy(mylist))
|
|
4457 < Uses the string representation of each item to sort on.
|
692
|
4458 Numbers sort after Strings, |Lists| after Numbers.
|
282
|
4459 For sorting text in the current buffer use |:sort|.
|
82
|
4460 When {func} is given and it is one then case is ignored.
|
685
|
4461 When {func} is a |Funcref| or a function name, this function
|
|
4462 is called to compare items. The function is invoked with two
|
82
|
4463 items as argument and must return zero if they are equal, 1 if
|
|
4464 the first one sorts after the second one, -1 if the first one
|
|
4465 sorts before the second one. Example: >
|
|
4466 func MyCompare(i1, i2)
|
|
4467 return a:i1 == a:i2 ? 0 : a:i1 > a:i2 ? 1 : -1
|
|
4468 endfunc
|
|
4469 let sortedlist = sort(mylist, "MyCompare")
|
344
|
4470 <
|
|
4471
|
374
|
4472 *soundfold()*
|
|
4473 soundfold({word})
|
|
4474 Return the sound-folded equivalent of {word}. Uses the first
|
|
4475 language in 'spellang' for the current window that supports
|
375
|
4476 soundfolding. 'spell' must be set. When no sound folding is
|
|
4477 possible the {word} is returned unmodified.
|
374
|
4478 This can be used for making spelling suggestions. Note that
|
|
4479 the method can be quite slow.
|
|
4480
|
344
|
4481 *spellbadword()*
|
532
|
4482 spellbadword([{sentence}])
|
|
4483 Without argument: The result is the badly spelled word under
|
|
4484 or after the cursor. The cursor is moved to the start of the
|
|
4485 bad word. When no bad word is found in the cursor line the
|
|
4486 result is an empty string and the cursor doesn't move.
|
|
4487
|
|
4488 With argument: The result is the first word in {sentence} that
|
|
4489 is badly spelled. If there are no spelling mistakes the
|
|
4490 result is an empty string.
|
|
4491
|
|
4492 The return value is a list with two items:
|
|
4493 - The badly spelled word or an empty string.
|
|
4494 - The type of the spelling error:
|
856
|
4495 "bad" spelling mistake
|
532
|
4496 "rare" rare word
|
|
4497 "local" word only valid in another region
|
|
4498 "caps" word should start with Capital
|
|
4499 Example: >
|
|
4500 echo spellbadword("the quik brown fox")
|
|
4501 < ['quik', 'bad'] ~
|
|
4502
|
|
4503 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
|
|
4504 'spell' option must be set and the value of 'spelllang' is
|
|
4505 used.
|
344
|
4506
|
|
4507 *spellsuggest()*
|
537
|
4508 spellsuggest({word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
|
685
|
4509 Return a |List| with spelling suggestions to replace {word}.
|
344
|
4510 When {max} is given up to this number of suggestions are
|
|
4511 returned. Otherwise up to 25 suggestions are returned.
|
|
4512
|
537
|
4513 When the {capital} argument is given and it's non-zero only
|
|
4514 suggestions with a leading capital will be given. Use this
|
|
4515 after a match with 'spellcapcheck'.
|
|
4516
|
344
|
4517 {word} can be a badly spelled word followed by other text.
|
|
4518 This allows for joining two words that were split. The
|
359
|
4519 suggestions also include the following text, thus you can
|
|
4520 replace a line.
|
|
4521
|
|
4522 {word} may also be a good word. Similar words will then be
|
537
|
4523 returned. {word} itself is not included in the suggestions,
|
|
4524 although it may appear capitalized.
|
344
|
4525
|
|
4526 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
|
375
|
4527 'spell' option must be set and the values of 'spelllang' and
|
|
4528 'spellsuggest' are used.
|
344
|
4529
|
82
|
4530
|
282
|
4531 split({expr} [, {pattern} [, {keepempty}]]) *split()*
|
685
|
4532 Make a |List| out of {expr}. When {pattern} is omitted or
|
|
4533 empty each white-separated sequence of characters becomes an
|
|
4534 item.
|
82
|
4535 Otherwise the string is split where {pattern} matches,
|
282
|
4536 removing the matched characters.
|
|
4537 When the first or last item is empty it is omitted, unless the
|
|
4538 {keepempty} argument is given and it's non-zero.
|
293
|
4539 Other empty items are kept when {pattern} matches at least one
|
|
4540 character or when {keepempty} is non-zero.
|
82
|
4541 Example: >
|
95
|
4542 :let words = split(getline('.'), '\W\+')
|
282
|
4543 < To split a string in individual characters: >
|
236
|
4544 :for c in split(mystring, '\zs')
|
258
|
4545 < If you want to keep the separator you can also use '\zs': >
|
|
4546 :echo split('abc:def:ghi', ':\zs')
|
|
4547 < ['abc:', 'def:', 'ghi'] ~
|
282
|
4548 Splitting a table where the first element can be empty: >
|
|
4549 :let items = split(line, ':', 1)
|
|
4550 < The opposite function is |join()|.
|
82
|
4551
|
|
4552
|
782
|
4553 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) *str2nr()*
|
|
4554 Convert string {expr} to a number.
|
|
4555 {base} is the conversion base, it can be 8, 10 or 16.
|
|
4556 When {base} is omitted base 10 is used. This also means that
|
|
4557 a leading zero doesn't cause octal conversion to be used, as
|
|
4558 with the default String to Number conversion.
|
|
4559 When {base} is 16 a leading "0x" or "0X" is ignored. With a
|
|
4560 different base the result will be zero.
|
|
4561 Text after the number is silently ignored.
|
856
|
4562
|
782
|
4563
|
7
|
4564 strftime({format} [, {time}]) *strftime()*
|
|
4565 The result is a String, which is a formatted date and time, as
|
|
4566 specified by the {format} string. The given {time} is used,
|
|
4567 or the current time if no time is given. The accepted
|
|
4568 {format} depends on your system, thus this is not portable!
|
|
4569 See the manual page of the C function strftime() for the
|
|
4570 format. The maximum length of the result is 80 characters.
|
|
4571 See also |localtime()| and |getftime()|.
|
|
4572 The language can be changed with the |:language| command.
|
|
4573 Examples: >
|
|
4574 :echo strftime("%c") Sun Apr 27 11:49:23 1997
|
|
4575 :echo strftime("%Y %b %d %X") 1997 Apr 27 11:53:25
|
|
4576 :echo strftime("%y%m%d %T") 970427 11:53:55
|
|
4577 :echo strftime("%H:%M") 11:55
|
|
4578 :echo strftime("%c", getftime("file.c"))
|
|
4579 Show mod time of file.c.
|
82
|
4580 < Not available on all systems. To check use: >
|
|
4581 :if exists("*strftime")
|
|
4582
|
133
|
4583 stridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *stridx()*
|
|
4584 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
|
|
4585 {haystack} of the first occurrence of the String {needle}.
|
140
|
4586 If {start} is specified, the search starts at index {start}.
|
|
4587 This can be used to find a second match: >
|
|
4588 :let comma1 = stridx(line, ",")
|
|
4589 :let comma2 = stridx(line, ",", comma1 + 1)
|
|
4590 < The search is done case-sensitive.
|
205
|
4591 For pattern searches use |match()|.
|
133
|
4592 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
|
140
|
4593 See also |strridx()|.
|
|
4594 Examples: >
|
7
|
4595 :echo stridx("An Example", "Example") 3
|
|
4596 :echo stridx("Starting point", "Start") 0
|
|
4597 :echo stridx("Starting point", "start") -1
|
856
|
4598 < *strstr()* *strchr()*
|
170
|
4599 stridx() works similar to the C function strstr(). When used
|
|
4600 with a single character it works similar to strchr().
|
|
4601
|
55
|
4602 *string()*
|
95
|
4603 string({expr}) Return {expr} converted to a String. If {expr} is a Number,
|
|
4604 String or a composition of them, then the result can be parsed
|
|
4605 back with |eval()|.
|
55
|
4606 {expr} type result ~
|
99
|
4607 String 'string'
|
95
|
4608 Number 123
|
99
|
4609 Funcref function('name')
|
95
|
4610 List [item, item]
|
323
|
4611 Dictionary {key: value, key: value}
|
99
|
4612 Note that in String values the ' character is doubled.
|
55
|
4613
|
7
|
4614 *strlen()*
|
|
4615 strlen({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the String
|
502
|
4616 {expr} in bytes.
|
|
4617 If you want to count the number of multi-byte characters (not
|
|
4618 counting composing characters) use something like this: >
|
7
|
4619
|
|
4620 :let len = strlen(substitute(str, ".", "x", "g"))
|
502
|
4621 <
|
55
|
4622 If the argument is a Number it is first converted to a String.
|
|
4623 For other types an error is given.
|
|
4624 Also see |len()|.
|
7
|
4625
|
|
4626 strpart({src}, {start}[, {len}]) *strpart()*
|
|
4627 The result is a String, which is part of {src}, starting from
|
574
|
4628 byte {start}, with the byte length {len}.
|
7
|
4629 When non-existing bytes are included, this doesn't result in
|
|
4630 an error, the bytes are simply omitted.
|
|
4631 If {len} is missing, the copy continues from {start} till the
|
|
4632 end of the {src}. >
|
|
4633 strpart("abcdefg", 3, 2) == "de"
|
|
4634 strpart("abcdefg", -2, 4) == "ab"
|
|
4635 strpart("abcdefg", 5, 4) == "fg"
|
|
4636 strpart("abcdefg", 3) == "defg"
|
|
4637 < Note: To get the first character, {start} must be 0. For
|
|
4638 example, to get three bytes under and after the cursor: >
|
823
|
4639 strpart(getline("."), col(".") - 1, 3)
|
7
|
4640 <
|
140
|
4641 strridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *strridx()*
|
|
4642 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
|
|
4643 {haystack} of the last occurrence of the String {needle}.
|
|
4644 When {start} is specified, matches beyond this index are
|
|
4645 ignored. This can be used to find a match before a previous
|
|
4646 match: >
|
|
4647 :let lastcomma = strridx(line, ",")
|
|
4648 :let comma2 = strridx(line, ",", lastcomma - 1)
|
|
4649 < The search is done case-sensitive.
|
133
|
4650 For pattern searches use |match()|.
|
|
4651 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
|
22
|
4652 If the {needle} is empty the length of {haystack} is returned.
|
236
|
4653 See also |stridx()|. Examples: >
|
7
|
4654 :echo strridx("an angry armadillo", "an") 3
|
856
|
4655 < *strrchr()*
|
170
|
4656 When used with a single character it works similar to the C
|
|
4657 function strrchr().
|
|
4658
|
7
|
4659 strtrans({expr}) *strtrans()*
|
|
4660 The result is a String, which is {expr} with all unprintable
|
|
4661 characters translated into printable characters |'isprint'|.
|
|
4662 Like they are shown in a window. Example: >
|
|
4663 echo strtrans(@a)
|
|
4664 < This displays a newline in register a as "^@" instead of
|
|
4665 starting a new line.
|
|
4666
|
|
4667 submatch({nr}) *submatch()*
|
|
4668 Only for an expression in a |:substitute| command. Returns
|
|
4669 the {nr}'th submatch of the matched text. When {nr} is 0
|
|
4670 the whole matched text is returned.
|
|
4671 Example: >
|
|
4672 :s/\d\+/\=submatch(0) + 1/
|
|
4673 < This finds the first number in the line and adds one to it.
|
|
4674 A line break is included as a newline character.
|
|
4675
|
|
4676 substitute({expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) *substitute()*
|
|
4677 The result is a String, which is a copy of {expr}, in which
|
|
4678 the first match of {pat} is replaced with {sub}. This works
|
|
4679 like the ":substitute" command (without any flags). But the
|
|
4680 matching with {pat} is always done like the 'magic' option is
|
|
4681 set and 'cpoptions' is empty (to make scripts portable).
|
872
|
4682 'ignorecase' is still relevant.
|
7
|
4683 See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
|
|
4684 And a "~" in {sub} is not replaced with the previous {sub}.
|
|
4685 Note that some codes in {sub} have a special meaning
|
|
4686 |sub-replace-special|. For example, to replace something with
|
|
4687 "\n" (two characters), use "\\\\n" or '\\n'.
|
|
4688 When {pat} does not match in {expr}, {expr} is returned
|
|
4689 unmodified.
|
|
4690 When {flags} is "g", all matches of {pat} in {expr} are
|
|
4691 replaced. Otherwise {flags} should be "".
|
|
4692 Example: >
|
|
4693 :let &path = substitute(&path, ",\\=[^,]*$", "", "")
|
|
4694 < This removes the last component of the 'path' option. >
|
|
4695 :echo substitute("testing", ".*", "\\U\\0", "")
|
|
4696 < results in "TESTING".
|
|
4697
|
32
|
4698 synID({lnum}, {col}, {trans}) *synID()*
|
7
|
4699 The result is a Number, which is the syntax ID at the position
|
32
|
4700 {lnum} and {col} in the current window.
|
7
|
4701 The syntax ID can be used with |synIDattr()| and
|
|
4702 |synIDtrans()| to obtain syntax information about text.
|
419
|
4703
|
32
|
4704 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
|
419
|
4705 line. 'synmaxcol' applies, in a longer line zero is returned.
|
|
4706
|
7
|
4707 When {trans} is non-zero, transparent items are reduced to the
|
|
4708 item that they reveal. This is useful when wanting to know
|
|
4709 the effective color. When {trans} is zero, the transparent
|
|
4710 item is returned. This is useful when wanting to know which
|
|
4711 syntax item is effective (e.g. inside parens).
|
|
4712 Warning: This function can be very slow. Best speed is
|
|
4713 obtained by going through the file in forward direction.
|
|
4714
|
|
4715 Example (echoes the name of the syntax item under the cursor): >
|
|
4716 :echo synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 1), "name")
|
|
4717 <
|
|
4718 synIDattr({synID}, {what} [, {mode}]) *synIDattr()*
|
|
4719 The result is a String, which is the {what} attribute of
|
|
4720 syntax ID {synID}. This can be used to obtain information
|
|
4721 about a syntax item.
|
|
4722 {mode} can be "gui", "cterm" or "term", to get the attributes
|
|
4723 for that mode. When {mode} is omitted, or an invalid value is
|
|
4724 used, the attributes for the currently active highlighting are
|
|
4725 used (GUI, cterm or term).
|
|
4726 Use synIDtrans() to follow linked highlight groups.
|
|
4727 {what} result
|
|
4728 "name" the name of the syntax item
|
|
4729 "fg" foreground color (GUI: color name used to set
|
|
4730 the color, cterm: color number as a string,
|
|
4731 term: empty string)
|
|
4732 "bg" background color (like "fg")
|
|
4733 "fg#" like "fg", but for the GUI and the GUI is
|
|
4734 running the name in "#RRGGBB" form
|
|
4735 "bg#" like "fg#" for "bg"
|
|
4736 "bold" "1" if bold
|
|
4737 "italic" "1" if italic
|
|
4738 "reverse" "1" if reverse
|
|
4739 "inverse" "1" if inverse (= reverse)
|
|
4740 "underline" "1" if underlined
|
205
|
4741 "undercurl" "1" if undercurled
|
7
|
4742
|
|
4743 Example (echoes the color of the syntax item under the
|
|
4744 cursor): >
|
|
4745 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(synID(line("."), col("."), 1)), "fg")
|
|
4746 <
|
|
4747 synIDtrans({synID}) *synIDtrans()*
|
|
4748 The result is a Number, which is the translated syntax ID of
|
|
4749 {synID}. This is the syntax group ID of what is being used to
|
|
4750 highlight the character. Highlight links given with
|
|
4751 ":highlight link" are followed.
|
|
4752
|
24
|
4753 system({expr} [, {input}]) *system()* *E677*
|
|
4754 Get the output of the shell command {expr}.
|
|
4755 When {input} is given, this string is written to a file and
|
|
4756 passed as stdin to the command. The string is written as-is,
|
|
4757 you need to take care of using the correct line separators
|
170
|
4758 yourself. Pipes are not used.
|
24
|
4759 Note: newlines in {expr} may cause the command to fail. The
|
|
4760 characters in 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote' may also cause
|
|
4761 trouble.
|
7
|
4762 This is not to be used for interactive commands.
|
|
4763 The result is a String. Example: >
|
|
4764
|
|
4765 :let files = system("ls")
|
|
4766
|
|
4767 < To make the result more system-independent, the shell output
|
|
4768 is filtered to replace <CR> with <NL> for Macintosh, and
|
|
4769 <CR><NL> with <NL> for DOS-like systems.
|
|
4770 The command executed is constructed using several options:
|
|
4771 'shell' 'shellcmdflag' 'shellxquote' {expr} 'shellredir' {tmp} 'shellxquote'
|
|
4772 ({tmp} is an automatically generated file name).
|
|
4773 For Unix and OS/2 braces are put around {expr} to allow for
|
|
4774 concatenated commands.
|
|
4775
|
794
|
4776 The command will be executed in "cooked" mode, so that a
|
|
4777 CTRL-C will interrupt the command (on Unix at least).
|
|
4778
|
7
|
4779 The resulting error code can be found in |v:shell_error|.
|
|
4780 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
|
625
|
4781
|
|
4782 Note that any wrong value in the options mentioned above may
|
|
4783 make the function fail. It has also been reported to fail
|
|
4784 when using a security agent application.
|
7
|
4785 Unlike ":!cmd" there is no automatic check for changed files.
|
|
4786 Use |:checktime| to force a check.
|
|
4787
|
205
|
4788
|
677
|
4789 tabpagebuflist([{arg}]) *tabpagebuflist()*
|
685
|
4790 The result is a |List|, where each item is the number of the
|
677
|
4791 buffer associated with each window in the current tab page.
|
|
4792 {arg} specifies the number of tab page to be used. When
|
|
4793 omitted the current tab page is used.
|
|
4794 When {arg} is invalid the number zero is returned.
|
|
4795 To get a list of all buffers in all tabs use this: >
|
|
4796 tablist = []
|
|
4797 for i in range(tabpagenr('$'))
|
|
4798 call extend(tablist, tabpagebuflist(i + 1))
|
|
4799 endfor
|
|
4800 < Note that a buffer may appear in more than one window.
|
|
4801
|
|
4802
|
|
4803 tabpagenr([{arg}]) *tabpagenr()*
|
674
|
4804 The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
|
|
4805 tab page. The first tab page has number 1.
|
|
4806 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the last tab
|
|
4807 page is returned (the tab page count).
|
|
4808 The number can be used with the |:tab| command.
|
|
4809
|
|
4810
|
677
|
4811 tabpagewinnr({tabarg}, [{arg}]) *tabpagewinnr()*
|
|
4812 Like |winnr()| but for tab page {arg}.
|
|
4813 {tabarg} specifies the number of tab page to be used.
|
|
4814 {arg} is used like with |winnr()|:
|
|
4815 - When omitted the current window number is returned. This is
|
|
4816 the window which will be used when going to this tab page.
|
|
4817 - When "$" the number of windows is returned.
|
|
4818 - When "#" the previous window nr is returned.
|
|
4819 Useful examples: >
|
|
4820 tabpagewinnr(1) " current window of tab page 1
|
|
4821 tabpagewinnr(4, '$') " number of windows in tab page 4
|
|
4822 < When {tabarg} is invalid zero is returned.
|
|
4823
|
805
|
4824 *tagfiles()*
|
|
4825 tagfiles() Returns a |List| with the file names used to search for tags
|
|
4826 for the current buffer. This is the 'tags' option expanded.
|
|
4827
|
|
4828
|
205
|
4829 taglist({expr}) *taglist()*
|
|
4830 Returns a list of tags matching the regular expression {expr}.
|
438
|
4831 Each list item is a dictionary with at least the following
|
|
4832 entries:
|
648
|
4833 name Name of the tag.
|
|
4834 filename Name of the file where the tag is
|
205
|
4835 defined.
|
|
4836 cmd Ex command used to locate the tag in
|
|
4837 the file.
|
648
|
4838 kind Type of the tag. The value for this
|
205
|
4839 entry depends on the language specific
|
|
4840 kind values generated by the ctags
|
|
4841 tool.
|
648
|
4842 static A file specific tag. Refer to
|
205
|
4843 |static-tag| for more information.
|
216
|
4844 The "kind" entry is only available when using Exuberant ctags
|
|
4845 generated tags file. More entries may be present, depending
|
|
4846 on the content of the tags file: access, implementation,
|
|
4847 inherits and signature. Refer to the ctags documentation for
|
|
4848 information about these fields. For C code the fields
|
|
4849 "struct", "class" and "enum" may appear, they give the name of
|
|
4850 the entity the tag is contained in.
|
452
|
4851
|
216
|
4852 The ex-command 'cmd' can be either an ex search pattern, a
|
|
4853 line number or a line number followed by a byte number.
|
205
|
4854
|
|
4855 If there are no matching tags, then an empty list is returned.
|
|
4856
|
|
4857 To get an exact tag match, the anchors '^' and '$' should be
|
|
4858 used in {expr}. Refer to |tag-regexp| for more information
|
|
4859 about the tag search regular expression pattern.
|
|
4860
|
|
4861 Refer to |'tags'| for information about how the tags file is
|
|
4862 located by Vim. Refer to |tags-file-format| for the format of
|
|
4863 the tags file generated by the different ctags tools.
|
|
4864
|
7
|
4865 tempname() *tempname()* *temp-file-name*
|
|
4866 The result is a String, which is the name of a file that
|
|
4867 doesn't exist. It can be used for a temporary file. The name
|
|
4868 is different for at least 26 consecutive calls. Example: >
|
|
4869 :let tmpfile = tempname()
|
|
4870 :exe "redir > " . tmpfile
|
|
4871 < For Unix, the file will be in a private directory (only
|
|
4872 accessible by the current user) to avoid security problems
|
|
4873 (e.g., a symlink attack or other people reading your file).
|
|
4874 When Vim exits the directory and all files in it are deleted.
|
|
4875 For MS-Windows forward slashes are used when the 'shellslash'
|
|
4876 option is set or when 'shellcmdflag' starts with '-'.
|
|
4877
|
|
4878 tolower({expr}) *tolower()*
|
|
4879 The result is a copy of the String given, with all uppercase
|
|
4880 characters turned into lowercase (just like applying |gu| to
|
|
4881 the string).
|
|
4882
|
|
4883 toupper({expr}) *toupper()*
|
|
4884 The result is a copy of the String given, with all lowercase
|
|
4885 characters turned into uppercase (just like applying |gU| to
|
|
4886 the string).
|
|
4887
|
15
|
4888 tr({src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) *tr()*
|
|
4889 The result is a copy of the {src} string with all characters
|
|
4890 which appear in {fromstr} replaced by the character in that
|
|
4891 position in the {tostr} string. Thus the first character in
|
|
4892 {fromstr} is translated into the first character in {tostr}
|
|
4893 and so on. Exactly like the unix "tr" command.
|
|
4894 This code also deals with multibyte characters properly.
|
|
4895
|
|
4896 Examples: >
|
|
4897 echo tr("hello there", "ht", "HT")
|
|
4898 < returns "Hello THere" >
|
|
4899 echo tr("<blob>", "<>", "{}")
|
|
4900 < returns "{blob}"
|
|
4901
|
87
|
4902 *type()*
|
|
4903 type({expr}) The result is a Number, depending on the type of {expr}:
|
153
|
4904 Number: 0
|
|
4905 String: 1
|
|
4906 Funcref: 2
|
|
4907 List: 3
|
|
4908 Dictionary: 4
|
|
4909 To avoid the magic numbers it should be used this way: >
|
87
|
4910 :if type(myvar) == type(0)
|
|
4911 :if type(myvar) == type("")
|
|
4912 :if type(myvar) == type(function("tr"))
|
|
4913 :if type(myvar) == type([])
|
153
|
4914 :if type(myvar) == type({})
|
7
|
4915
|
140
|
4916 values({dict}) *values()*
|
685
|
4917 Return a |List| with all the values of {dict}. The |List| is
|
|
4918 in arbitrary order.
|
140
|
4919
|
|
4920
|
7
|
4921 virtcol({expr}) *virtcol()*
|
|
4922 The result is a Number, which is the screen column of the file
|
|
4923 position given with {expr}. That is, the last screen position
|
|
4924 occupied by the character at that position, when the screen
|
|
4925 would be of unlimited width. When there is a <Tab> at the
|
|
4926 position, the returned Number will be the column at the end of
|
|
4927 the <Tab>. For example, for a <Tab> in column 1, with 'ts'
|
|
4928 set to 8, it returns 8.
|
685
|
4929 For the use of {expr} see |col()|. Additionally you can use
|
688
|
4930 [lnum, col]: a |List| with the line and column number. When
|
|
4931 "lnum" or "col" is out of range then virtcol() returns zero.
|
703
|
4932 When 'virtualedit' is used it can be [lnum, col, off], where
|
|
4933 "off" is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
|
|
4934 character. E.g., a position within a Tab or after the last
|
|
4935 character.
|
7
|
4936 For the byte position use |col()|.
|
|
4937 When Virtual editing is active in the current mode, a position
|
|
4938 beyond the end of the line can be returned. |'virtualedit'|
|
|
4939 The accepted positions are:
|
|
4940 . the cursor position
|
|
4941 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
|
|
4942 number of displayed characters in the cursor line
|
|
4943 plus one)
|
|
4944 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
|
4945 returned)
|
|
4946 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
|
|
4947 Examples: >
|
|
4948 virtcol(".") with text "foo^Lbar", with cursor on the "^L", returns 5
|
|
4949 virtcol("$") with text "foo^Lbar", returns 9
|
|
4950 virtcol("'t") with text " there", with 't at 'h', returns 6
|
|
4951 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
|
|
4952
|
|
4953 visualmode([expr]) *visualmode()*
|
|
4954 The result is a String, which describes the last Visual mode
|
856
|
4955 used in the current buffer. Initially it returns an empty
|
|
4956 string, but once Visual mode has been used, it returns "v",
|
|
4957 "V", or "<CTRL-V>" (a single CTRL-V character) for
|
|
4958 character-wise, line-wise, or block-wise Visual mode
|
|
4959 respectively.
|
7
|
4960 Example: >
|
|
4961 :exe "normal " . visualmode()
|
|
4962 < This enters the same Visual mode as before. It is also useful
|
|
4963 in scripts if you wish to act differently depending on the
|
|
4964 Visual mode that was used.
|
|
4965
|
|
4966 If an expression is supplied that results in a non-zero number
|
|
4967 or a non-empty string, then the Visual mode will be cleared
|
|
4968 and the old value is returned. Note that " " and "0" are also
|
|
4969 non-empty strings, thus cause the mode to be cleared.
|
|
4970
|
|
4971 *winbufnr()*
|
|
4972 winbufnr({nr}) The result is a Number, which is the number of the buffer
|
236
|
4973 associated with window {nr}. When {nr} is zero, the number of
|
7
|
4974 the buffer in the current window is returned. When window
|
|
4975 {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
4976 Example: >
|
|
4977 :echo "The file in the current window is " . bufname(winbufnr(0))
|
|
4978 <
|
|
4979 *wincol()*
|
|
4980 wincol() The result is a Number, which is the virtual column of the
|
|
4981 cursor in the window. This is counting screen cells from the
|
|
4982 left side of the window. The leftmost column is one.
|
|
4983
|
|
4984 winheight({nr}) *winheight()*
|
|
4985 The result is a Number, which is the height of window {nr}.
|
|
4986 When {nr} is zero, the height of the current window is
|
|
4987 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
4988 An existing window always has a height of zero or more.
|
|
4989 Examples: >
|
|
4990 :echo "The current window has " . winheight(0) . " lines."
|
|
4991 <
|
|
4992 *winline()*
|
|
4993 winline() The result is a Number, which is the screen line of the cursor
|
|
4994 in the window. This is counting screen lines from the top of
|
|
4995 the window. The first line is one.
|
531
|
4996 If the cursor was moved the view on the file will be updated
|
|
4997 first, this may cause a scroll.
|
7
|
4998
|
|
4999 *winnr()*
|
20
|
5000 winnr([{arg}]) The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
|
|
5001 window. The top window has number 1.
|
|
5002 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the
|
674
|
5003 last window is returned (the window count).
|
20
|
5004 When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last
|
|
5005 accessed window is returned (where |CTRL-W_p| goes to).
|
|
5006 If there is no previous window 0 is returned.
|
|
5007 The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
|
|
5008 |:wincmd|.
|
7
|
5009
|
|
5010 *winrestcmd()*
|
|
5011 winrestcmd() Returns a sequence of |:resize| commands that should restore
|
|
5012 the current window sizes. Only works properly when no windows
|
712
|
5013 are opened or closed and the current window and tab page is
|
|
5014 unchanged.
|
7
|
5015 Example: >
|
|
5016 :let cmd = winrestcmd()
|
|
5017 :call MessWithWindowSizes()
|
|
5018 :exe cmd
|
712
|
5019 <
|
|
5020 *winrestview()*
|
|
5021 winrestview({dict})
|
|
5022 Uses the |Dictionary| returned by |winsaveview()| to restore
|
|
5023 the view of the current window.
|
|
5024 If you have changed the values the result is unpredictable.
|
|
5025 If the window size changed the result won't be the same.
|
|
5026
|
|
5027 *winsaveview()*
|
|
5028 winsaveview() Returns a |Dictionary| that contains information to restore
|
|
5029 the view of the current window. Use |winrestview()| to
|
|
5030 restore the view.
|
|
5031 This is useful if you have a mapping that jumps around in the
|
|
5032 buffer and you want to go back to the original view.
|
|
5033 This does not save fold information. Use the 'foldenable'
|
798
|
5034 option to temporarily switch off folding, so that folds are
|
|
5035 not opened when moving around.
|
712
|
5036 The return value includes:
|
|
5037 lnum cursor line number
|
|
5038 col cursor column
|
|
5039 coladd cursor column offset for 'virtualedit'
|
|
5040 curswant column for vertical movement
|
|
5041 topline first line in the window
|
|
5042 topfill filler lines, only in diff mode
|
|
5043 leftcol first column displayed
|
|
5044 skipcol columns skipped
|
|
5045 Note that no option values are saved.
|
|
5046
|
7
|
5047
|
|
5048 winwidth({nr}) *winwidth()*
|
|
5049 The result is a Number, which is the width of window {nr}.
|
|
5050 When {nr} is zero, the width of the current window is
|
|
5051 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
|
|
5052 An existing window always has a width of zero or more.
|
|
5053 Examples: >
|
|
5054 :echo "The current window has " . winwidth(0) . " columns."
|
|
5055 :if winwidth(0) <= 50
|
|
5056 : exe "normal 50\<C-W>|"
|
|
5057 :endif
|
|
5058 <
|
158
|
5059 *writefile()*
|
|
5060 writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
|
685
|
5061 Write |List| {list} to file {fname}. Each list item is
|
158
|
5062 separated with a NL. Each list item must be a String or
|
|
5063 Number.
|
|
5064 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used: There will
|
|
5065 not be a NL after the last list item. An empty item at the
|
|
5066 end does cause the last line in the file to end in a NL.
|
|
5067 All NL characters are replaced with a NUL character.
|
|
5068 Inserting CR characters needs to be done before passing {list}
|
|
5069 to writefile().
|
|
5070 An existing file is overwritten, if possible.
|
|
5071 When the write fails -1 is returned, otherwise 0. There is an
|
|
5072 error message if the file can't be created or when writing
|
|
5073 fails.
|
|
5074 Also see |readfile()|.
|
|
5075 To copy a file byte for byte: >
|
|
5076 :let fl = readfile("foo", "b")
|
|
5077 :call writefile(fl, "foocopy", "b")
|
|
5078 <
|
7
|
5079
|
|
5080 *feature-list*
|
|
5081 There are three types of features:
|
|
5082 1. Features that are only supported when they have been enabled when Vim
|
|
5083 was compiled |+feature-list|. Example: >
|
|
5084 :if has("cindent")
|
|
5085 2. Features that are only supported when certain conditions have been met.
|
|
5086 Example: >
|
|
5087 :if has("gui_running")
|
|
5088 < *has-patch*
|
|
5089 3. Included patches. First check |v:version| for the version of Vim.
|
|
5090 Then the "patch123" feature means that patch 123 has been included for
|
|
5091 this version. Example (checking version 6.2.148 or later): >
|
|
5092 :if v:version > 602 || v:version == 602 && has("patch148")
|
|
5093
|
|
5094 all_builtin_terms Compiled with all builtin terminals enabled.
|
|
5095 amiga Amiga version of Vim.
|
|
5096 arabic Compiled with Arabic support |Arabic|.
|
|
5097 arp Compiled with ARP support (Amiga).
|
613
|
5098 autocmd Compiled with autocommand support. |autocommand|
|
7
|
5099 balloon_eval Compiled with |balloon-eval| support.
|
435
|
5100 balloon_multiline GUI supports multiline balloons.
|
7
|
5101 beos BeOS version of Vim.
|
|
5102 browse Compiled with |:browse| support, and browse() will
|
|
5103 work.
|
|
5104 builtin_terms Compiled with some builtin terminals.
|
|
5105 byte_offset Compiled with support for 'o' in 'statusline'
|
|
5106 cindent Compiled with 'cindent' support.
|
|
5107 clientserver Compiled with remote invocation support |clientserver|.
|
|
5108 clipboard Compiled with 'clipboard' support.
|
|
5109 cmdline_compl Compiled with |cmdline-completion| support.
|
|
5110 cmdline_hist Compiled with |cmdline-history| support.
|
|
5111 cmdline_info Compiled with 'showcmd' and 'ruler' support.
|
|
5112 comments Compiled with |'comments'| support.
|
|
5113 cryptv Compiled with encryption support |encryption|.
|
|
5114 cscope Compiled with |cscope| support.
|
|
5115 compatible Compiled to be very Vi compatible.
|
|
5116 debug Compiled with "DEBUG" defined.
|
|
5117 dialog_con Compiled with console dialog support.
|
|
5118 dialog_gui Compiled with GUI dialog support.
|
|
5119 diff Compiled with |vimdiff| and 'diff' support.
|
|
5120 digraphs Compiled with support for digraphs.
|
|
5121 dnd Compiled with support for the "~ register |quote_~|.
|
|
5122 dos32 32 bits DOS (DJGPP) version of Vim.
|
|
5123 dos16 16 bits DOS version of Vim.
|
|
5124 ebcdic Compiled on a machine with ebcdic character set.
|
|
5125 emacs_tags Compiled with support for Emacs tags.
|
|
5126 eval Compiled with expression evaluation support. Always
|
|
5127 true, of course!
|
|
5128 ex_extra Compiled with extra Ex commands |+ex_extra|.
|
|
5129 extra_search Compiled with support for |'incsearch'| and
|
|
5130 |'hlsearch'|
|
|
5131 farsi Compiled with Farsi support |farsi|.
|
|
5132 file_in_path Compiled with support for |gf| and |<cfile>|
|
168
|
5133 filterpipe When 'shelltemp' is off pipes are used for shell
|
|
5134 read/write/filter commands
|
7
|
5135 find_in_path Compiled with support for include file searches
|
|
5136 |+find_in_path|.
|
|
5137 fname_case Case in file names matters (for Amiga, MS-DOS, and
|
|
5138 Windows this is not present).
|
|
5139 folding Compiled with |folding| support.
|
|
5140 footer Compiled with GUI footer support. |gui-footer|
|
|
5141 fork Compiled to use fork()/exec() instead of system().
|
|
5142 gettext Compiled with message translation |multi-lang|
|
|
5143 gui Compiled with GUI enabled.
|
|
5144 gui_athena Compiled with Athena GUI.
|
|
5145 gui_gtk Compiled with GTK+ GUI (any version).
|
|
5146 gui_gtk2 Compiled with GTK+ 2 GUI (gui_gtk is also defined).
|
|
5147 gui_mac Compiled with Macintosh GUI.
|
|
5148 gui_motif Compiled with Motif GUI.
|
|
5149 gui_photon Compiled with Photon GUI.
|
|
5150 gui_win32 Compiled with MS Windows Win32 GUI.
|
|
5151 gui_win32s idem, and Win32s system being used (Windows 3.1)
|
|
5152 gui_running Vim is running in the GUI, or it will start soon.
|
|
5153 hangul_input Compiled with Hangul input support. |hangul|
|
|
5154 iconv Can use iconv() for conversion.
|
|
5155 insert_expand Compiled with support for CTRL-X expansion commands in
|
|
5156 Insert mode.
|
|
5157 jumplist Compiled with |jumplist| support.
|
|
5158 keymap Compiled with 'keymap' support.
|
|
5159 langmap Compiled with 'langmap' support.
|
|
5160 libcall Compiled with |libcall()| support.
|
|
5161 linebreak Compiled with 'linebreak', 'breakat' and 'showbreak'
|
|
5162 support.
|
|
5163 lispindent Compiled with support for lisp indenting.
|
|
5164 listcmds Compiled with commands for the buffer list |:files|
|
|
5165 and the argument list |arglist|.
|
|
5166 localmap Compiled with local mappings and abbr. |:map-local|
|
|
5167 mac Macintosh version of Vim.
|
|
5168 macunix Macintosh version of Vim, using Unix files (OS-X).
|
|
5169 menu Compiled with support for |:menu|.
|
|
5170 mksession Compiled with support for |:mksession|.
|
|
5171 modify_fname Compiled with file name modifiers. |filename-modifiers|
|
|
5172 mouse Compiled with support mouse.
|
|
5173 mouseshape Compiled with support for 'mouseshape'.
|
|
5174 mouse_dec Compiled with support for Dec terminal mouse.
|
|
5175 mouse_gpm Compiled with support for gpm (Linux console mouse)
|
|
5176 mouse_netterm Compiled with support for netterm mouse.
|
|
5177 mouse_pterm Compiled with support for qnx pterm mouse.
|
|
5178 mouse_xterm Compiled with support for xterm mouse.
|
|
5179 multi_byte Compiled with support for editing Korean et al.
|
|
5180 multi_byte_ime Compiled with support for IME input method.
|
|
5181 multi_lang Compiled with support for multiple languages.
|
14
|
5182 mzscheme Compiled with MzScheme interface |mzscheme|.
|
7
|
5183 netbeans_intg Compiled with support for |netbeans|.
|
33
|
5184 netbeans_enabled Compiled with support for |netbeans| and it's used.
|
7
|
5185 ole Compiled with OLE automation support for Win32.
|
|
5186 os2 OS/2 version of Vim.
|
|
5187 osfiletype Compiled with support for osfiletypes |+osfiletype|
|
|
5188 path_extra Compiled with up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags'
|
|
5189 perl Compiled with Perl interface.
|
|
5190 postscript Compiled with PostScript file printing.
|
|
5191 printer Compiled with |:hardcopy| support.
|
170
|
5192 profile Compiled with |:profile| support.
|
7
|
5193 python Compiled with Python interface.
|
|
5194 qnx QNX version of Vim.
|
|
5195 quickfix Compiled with |quickfix| support.
|
857
|
5196 reltime Compiled with |reltime()| support.
|
7
|
5197 rightleft Compiled with 'rightleft' support.
|
|
5198 ruby Compiled with Ruby interface |ruby|.
|
|
5199 scrollbind Compiled with 'scrollbind' support.
|
|
5200 showcmd Compiled with 'showcmd' support.
|
|
5201 signs Compiled with |:sign| support.
|
|
5202 smartindent Compiled with 'smartindent' support.
|
9
|
5203 sniff Compiled with SNiFF interface support.
|
7
|
5204 statusline Compiled with support for 'statusline', 'rulerformat'
|
|
5205 and special formats of 'titlestring' and 'iconstring'.
|
|
5206 sun_workshop Compiled with support for Sun |workshop|.
|
314
|
5207 spell Compiled with spell checking support |spell|.
|
|
5208 syntax Compiled with syntax highlighting support |syntax|.
|
7
|
5209 syntax_items There are active syntax highlighting items for the
|
|
5210 current buffer.
|
|
5211 system Compiled to use system() instead of fork()/exec().
|
|
5212 tag_binary Compiled with binary searching in tags files
|
|
5213 |tag-binary-search|.
|
|
5214 tag_old_static Compiled with support for old static tags
|
|
5215 |tag-old-static|.
|
|
5216 tag_any_white Compiled with support for any white characters in tags
|
|
5217 files |tag-any-white|.
|
|
5218 tcl Compiled with Tcl interface.
|
|
5219 terminfo Compiled with terminfo instead of termcap.
|
|
5220 termresponse Compiled with support for |t_RV| and |v:termresponse|.
|
|
5221 textobjects Compiled with support for |text-objects|.
|
|
5222 tgetent Compiled with tgetent support, able to use a termcap
|
|
5223 or terminfo file.
|
|
5224 title Compiled with window title support |'title'|.
|
|
5225 toolbar Compiled with support for |gui-toolbar|.
|
|
5226 unix Unix version of Vim.
|
|
5227 user_commands User-defined commands.
|
|
5228 viminfo Compiled with viminfo support.
|
|
5229 vim_starting True while initial source'ing takes place.
|
|
5230 vertsplit Compiled with vertically split windows |:vsplit|.
|
|
5231 virtualedit Compiled with 'virtualedit' option.
|
|
5232 visual Compiled with Visual mode.
|
|
5233 visualextra Compiled with extra Visual mode commands.
|
|
5234 |blockwise-operators|.
|
|
5235 vms VMS version of Vim.
|
|
5236 vreplace Compiled with |gR| and |gr| commands.
|
|
5237 wildignore Compiled with 'wildignore' option.
|
|
5238 wildmenu Compiled with 'wildmenu' option.
|
|
5239 windows Compiled with support for more than one window.
|
|
5240 winaltkeys Compiled with 'winaltkeys' option.
|
|
5241 win16 Win16 version of Vim (MS-Windows 3.1).
|
|
5242 win32 Win32 version of Vim (MS-Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000/XP).
|
|
5243 win64 Win64 version of Vim (MS-Windows 64 bit).
|
|
5244 win32unix Win32 version of Vim, using Unix files (Cygwin)
|
|
5245 win95 Win32 version for MS-Windows 95/98/ME.
|
|
5246 writebackup Compiled with 'writebackup' default on.
|
|
5247 xfontset Compiled with X fontset support |xfontset|.
|
|
5248 xim Compiled with X input method support |xim|.
|
|
5249 xsmp Compiled with X session management support.
|
|
5250 xsmp_interact Compiled with interactive X session management support.
|
|
5251 xterm_clipboard Compiled with support for xterm clipboard.
|
|
5252 xterm_save Compiled with support for saving and restoring the
|
|
5253 xterm screen.
|
|
5254 x11 Compiled with X11 support.
|
|
5255
|
|
5256 *string-match*
|
|
5257 Matching a pattern in a String
|
|
5258
|
|
5259 A regexp pattern as explained at |pattern| is normally used to find a match in
|
|
5260 the buffer lines. When a pattern is used to find a match in a String, almost
|
|
5261 everything works in the same way. The difference is that a String is handled
|
|
5262 like it is one line. When it contains a "\n" character, this is not seen as a
|
|
5263 line break for the pattern. It can be matched with a "\n" in the pattern, or
|
|
5264 with ".". Example: >
|
|
5265 :let a = "aaaa\nxxxx"
|
|
5266 :echo matchstr(a, "..\n..")
|
|
5267 aa
|
|
5268 xx
|
|
5269 :echo matchstr(a, "a.x")
|
|
5270 a
|
|
5271 x
|
|
5272
|
|
5273 Don't forget that "^" will only match at the first character of the String and
|
|
5274 "$" at the last character of the string. They don't match after or before a
|
|
5275 "\n".
|
|
5276
|
|
5277 ==============================================================================
|
|
5278 5. Defining functions *user-functions*
|
|
5279
|
|
5280 New functions can be defined. These can be called just like builtin
|
|
5281 functions. The function executes a sequence of Ex commands. Normal mode
|
|
5282 commands can be executed with the |:normal| command.
|
|
5283
|
|
5284 The function name must start with an uppercase letter, to avoid confusion with
|
|
5285 builtin functions. To prevent from using the same name in different scripts
|
|
5286 avoid obvious, short names. A good habit is to start the function name with
|
|
5287 the name of the script, e.g., "HTMLcolor()".
|
|
5288
|
504
|
5289 It's also possible to use curly braces, see |curly-braces-names|. And the
|
|
5290 |autoload| facility is useful to define a function only when it's called.
|
7
|
5291
|
|
5292 *local-function*
|
|
5293 A function local to a script must start with "s:". A local script function
|
|
5294 can only be called from within the script and from functions, user commands
|
|
5295 and autocommands defined in the script. It is also possible to call the
|
|
5296 function from a mappings defined in the script, but then |<SID>| must be used
|
|
5297 instead of "s:" when the mapping is expanded outside of the script.
|
|
5298
|
|
5299 *:fu* *:function* *E128* *E129* *E123*
|
|
5300 :fu[nction] List all functions and their arguments.
|
|
5301
|
|
5302 :fu[nction] {name} List function {name}.
|
685
|
5303 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5304 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5305 :function dict.init
|
504
|
5306
|
|
5307 :fu[nction] /{pattern} List functions with a name matching {pattern}.
|
|
5308 Example that lists all functions ending with "File": >
|
|
5309 :function /File$
|
482
|
5310 <
|
|
5311 *:function-verbose*
|
|
5312 When 'verbose' is non-zero, listing a function will also display where it was
|
|
5313 last defined. Example: >
|
|
5314
|
|
5315 :verbose function SetFileTypeSH
|
|
5316 function SetFileTypeSH(name)
|
|
5317 Last set from /usr/share/vim/vim-7.0/filetype.vim
|
|
5318 <
|
484
|
5319 See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
|
482
|
5320
|
856
|
5321 *E124* *E125*
|
102
|
5322 :fu[nction][!] {name}([arguments]) [range] [abort] [dict]
|
7
|
5323 Define a new function by the name {name}. The name
|
|
5324 must be made of alphanumeric characters and '_', and
|
|
5325 must start with a capital or "s:" (see above).
|
114
|
5326
|
685
|
5327 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5328 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5329 :function dict.init(arg)
|
|
5330 < "dict" must be an existing dictionary. The entry
|
|
5331 "init" is added if it didn't exist yet. Otherwise [!]
|
|
5332 is required to overwrite an existing function. The
|
|
5333 result is a |Funcref| to a numbered function. The
|
|
5334 function can only be used with a |Funcref| and will be
|
|
5335 deleted if there are no more references to it.
|
7
|
5336 *E127* *E122*
|
|
5337 When a function by this name already exists and [!] is
|
|
5338 not used an error message is given. When [!] is used,
|
|
5339 an existing function is silently replaced. Unless it
|
|
5340 is currently being executed, that is an error.
|
133
|
5341
|
|
5342 For the {arguments} see |function-argument|.
|
|
5343
|
7
|
5344 *a:firstline* *a:lastline*
|
|
5345 When the [range] argument is added, the function is
|
|
5346 expected to take care of a range itself. The range is
|
|
5347 passed as "a:firstline" and "a:lastline". If [range]
|
|
5348 is excluded, ":{range}call" will call the function for
|
|
5349 each line in the range, with the cursor on the start
|
|
5350 of each line. See |function-range-example|.
|
114
|
5351
|
7
|
5352 When the [abort] argument is added, the function will
|
|
5353 abort as soon as an error is detected.
|
114
|
5354
|
102
|
5355 When the [dict] argument is added, the function must
|
685
|
5356 be invoked through an entry in a |Dictionary|. The
|
102
|
5357 local variable "self" will then be set to the
|
|
5358 dictionary. See |Dictionary-function|.
|
7
|
5359
|
653
|
5360 The last used search pattern and the redo command "."
|
|
5361 will not be changed by the function.
|
|
5362
|
7
|
5363 *:endf* *:endfunction* *E126* *E193*
|
|
5364 :endf[unction] The end of a function definition. Must be on a line
|
|
5365 by its own, without other commands.
|
|
5366
|
|
5367 *:delf* *:delfunction* *E130* *E131*
|
|
5368 :delf[unction] {name} Delete function {name}.
|
685
|
5369 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
|
|
5370 |Funcref|: >
|
114
|
5371 :delfunc dict.init
|
|
5372 < This will remove the "init" entry from "dict". The
|
|
5373 function is deleted if there are no more references to
|
|
5374 it.
|
7
|
5375 *:retu* *:return* *E133*
|
|
5376 :retu[rn] [expr] Return from a function. When "[expr]" is given, it is
|
|
5377 evaluated and returned as the result of the function.
|
|
5378 If "[expr]" is not given, the number 0 is returned.
|
|
5379 When a function ends without an explicit ":return",
|
|
5380 the number 0 is returned.
|
|
5381 Note that there is no check for unreachable lines,
|
|
5382 thus there is no warning if commands follow ":return".
|
|
5383
|
|
5384 If the ":return" is used after a |:try| but before the
|
|
5385 matching |:finally| (if present), the commands
|
|
5386 following the ":finally" up to the matching |:endtry|
|
|
5387 are executed first. This process applies to all
|
|
5388 nested ":try"s inside the function. The function
|
|
5389 returns at the outermost ":endtry".
|
|
5390
|
133
|
5391 *function-argument* *a:var*
|
|
5392 An argument can be defined by giving its name. In the function this can then
|
|
5393 be used as "a:name" ("a:" for argument).
|
|
5394 *a:0* *a:1* *a:000* *E740*
|
|
5395 Up to 20 arguments can be given, separated by commas. After the named
|
|
5396 arguments an argument "..." can be specified, which means that more arguments
|
|
5397 may optionally be following. In the function the extra arguments can be used
|
|
5398 as "a:1", "a:2", etc. "a:0" is set to the number of extra arguments (which
|
685
|
5399 can be 0). "a:000" is set to a |List| that contains these arguments. Note
|
|
5400 that "a:1" is the same as "a:000[0]".
|
148
|
5401 *E742*
|
|
5402 The a: scope and the variables in it cannot be changed, they are fixed.
|
685
|
5403 However, if a |List| or |Dictionary| is used, you can changes their contents.
|
|
5404 Thus you can pass a |List| to a function and have the function add an item to
|
|
5405 it. If you want to make sure the function cannot change a |List| or
|
|
5406 |Dictionary| use |:lockvar|.
|
133
|
5407
|
|
5408 When not using "...", the number of arguments in a function call must be equal
|
|
5409 to the number of named arguments. When using "...", the number of arguments
|
|
5410 may be larger.
|
|
5411
|
|
5412 It is also possible to define a function without any arguments. You must
|
|
5413 still supply the () then. The body of the function follows in the next lines,
|
|
5414 until the matching |:endfunction|. It is allowed to define another function
|
|
5415 inside a function body.
|
|
5416
|
|
5417 *local-variables*
|
7
|
5418 Inside a function variables can be used. These are local variables, which
|
|
5419 will disappear when the function returns. Global variables need to be
|
|
5420 accessed with "g:".
|
|
5421
|
|
5422 Example: >
|
|
5423 :function Table(title, ...)
|
|
5424 : echohl Title
|
|
5425 : echo a:title
|
|
5426 : echohl None
|
140
|
5427 : echo a:0 . " items:"
|
|
5428 : for s in a:000
|
|
5429 : echon ' ' . s
|
|
5430 : endfor
|
7
|
5431 :endfunction
|
|
5432
|
|
5433 This function can then be called with: >
|
140
|
5434 call Table("Table", "line1", "line2")
|
|
5435 call Table("Empty Table")
|
7
|
5436
|
|
5437 To return more than one value, pass the name of a global variable: >
|
|
5438 :function Compute(n1, n2, divname)
|
|
5439 : if a:n2 == 0
|
|
5440 : return "fail"
|
|
5441 : endif
|
|
5442 : let g:{a:divname} = a:n1 / a:n2
|
|
5443 : return "ok"
|
|
5444 :endfunction
|
|
5445
|
|
5446 This function can then be called with: >
|
|
5447 :let success = Compute(13, 1324, "div")
|
|
5448 :if success == "ok"
|
|
5449 : echo div
|
|
5450 :endif
|
|
5451
|
|
5452 An alternative is to return a command that can be executed. This also works
|
|
5453 with local variables in a calling function. Example: >
|
|
5454 :function Foo()
|
|
5455 : execute Bar()
|
|
5456 : echo "line " . lnum . " column " . col
|
|
5457 :endfunction
|
|
5458
|
|
5459 :function Bar()
|
|
5460 : return "let lnum = " . line(".") . " | let col = " . col(".")
|
|
5461 :endfunction
|
|
5462
|
|
5463 The names "lnum" and "col" could also be passed as argument to Bar(), to allow
|
|
5464 the caller to set the names.
|
|
5465
|
786
|
5466 *:cal* *:call* *E107* *E117*
|
7
|
5467 :[range]cal[l] {name}([arguments])
|
|
5468 Call a function. The name of the function and its arguments
|
|
5469 are as specified with |:function|. Up to 20 arguments can be
|
|
5470 used.
|
|
5471 Without a range and for functions that accept a range, the
|
|
5472 function is called once. When a range is given the cursor is
|
|
5473 positioned at the start of the first line before executing the
|
|
5474 function.
|
|
5475 When a range is given and the function doesn't handle it
|
|
5476 itself, the function is executed for each line in the range,
|
|
5477 with the cursor in the first column of that line. The cursor
|
|
5478 is left at the last line (possibly moved by the last function
|
|
5479 call). The arguments are re-evaluated for each line. Thus
|
|
5480 this works:
|
|
5481 *function-range-example* >
|
|
5482 :function Mynumber(arg)
|
|
5483 : echo line(".") . " " . a:arg
|
|
5484 :endfunction
|
|
5485 :1,5call Mynumber(getline("."))
|
|
5486 <
|
|
5487 The "a:firstline" and "a:lastline" are defined anyway, they
|
|
5488 can be used to do something different at the start or end of
|
|
5489 the range.
|
|
5490
|
|
5491 Example of a function that handles the range itself: >
|
|
5492
|
|
5493 :function Cont() range
|
|
5494 : execute (a:firstline + 1) . "," . a:lastline . 's/^/\t\\ '
|
|
5495 :endfunction
|
|
5496 :4,8call Cont()
|
|
5497 <
|
|
5498 This function inserts the continuation character "\" in front
|
|
5499 of all the lines in the range, except the first one.
|
|
5500
|
|
5501 *E132*
|
|
5502 The recursiveness of user functions is restricted with the |'maxfuncdepth'|
|
|
5503 option.
|
|
5504
|
161
|
5505
|
|
5506 AUTOMATICALLY LOADING FUNCTIONS ~
|
7
|
5507 *autoload-functions*
|
|
5508 When using many or large functions, it's possible to automatically define them
|
161
|
5509 only when they are used. There are two methods: with an autocommand and with
|
|
5510 the "autoload" directory in 'runtimepath'.
|
|
5511
|
|
5512
|
|
5513 Using an autocommand ~
|
|
5514
|
170
|
5515 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.14|.
|
|
5516
|
161
|
5517 The autocommand is useful if you have a plugin that is a long Vim script file.
|
|
5518 You can define the autocommand and quickly quit the script with |:finish|.
|
|
5519 That makes Vim startup faster. The autocommand should then load the same file
|
|
5520 again, setting a variable to skip the |:finish| command.
|
|
5521
|
|
5522 Use the FuncUndefined autocommand event with a pattern that matches the
|
|
5523 function(s) to be defined. Example: >
|
7
|
5524
|
|
5525 :au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim
|
|
5526
|
|
5527 The file "~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim" should then define functions that start with
|
|
5528 "BufNet". Also see |FuncUndefined|.
|
|
5529
|
161
|
5530
|
|
5531 Using an autoload script ~
|
168
|
5532 *autoload* *E746*
|
170
|
5533 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.15|.
|
|
5534
|
161
|
5535 Using a script in the "autoload" directory is simpler, but requires using
|
|
5536 exactly the right file name. A function that can be autoloaded has a name
|
|
5537 like this: >
|
|
5538
|
270
|
5539 :call filename#funcname()
|
161
|
5540
|
|
5541 When such a function is called, and it is not defined yet, Vim will search the
|
|
5542 "autoload" directories in 'runtimepath' for a script file called
|
|
5543 "filename.vim". For example "~/.vim/autoload/filename.vim". That file should
|
|
5544 then define the function like this: >
|
|
5545
|
270
|
5546 function filename#funcname()
|
161
|
5547 echo "Done!"
|
|
5548 endfunction
|
|
5549
|
530
|
5550 The file name and the name used before the # in the function must match
|
161
|
5551 exactly, and the defined function must have the name exactly as it will be
|
|
5552 called.
|
|
5553
|
270
|
5554 It is possible to use subdirectories. Every # in the function name works like
|
|
5555 a path separator. Thus when calling a function: >
|
|
5556
|
|
5557 :call foo#bar#func()
|
161
|
5558
|
|
5559 Vim will look for the file "autoload/foo/bar.vim" in 'runtimepath'.
|
|
5560
|
168
|
5561 This also works when reading a variable that has not been set yet: >
|
|
5562
|
270
|
5563 :let l = foo#bar#lvar
|
168
|
5564
|
557
|
5565 However, when the autoload script was already loaded it won't be loaded again
|
|
5566 for an unknown variable.
|
|
5567
|
168
|
5568 When assigning a value to such a variable nothing special happens. This can
|
|
5569 be used to pass settings to the autoload script before it's loaded: >
|
|
5570
|
270
|
5571 :let foo#bar#toggle = 1
|
|
5572 :call foo#bar#func()
|
168
|
5573
|
164
|
5574 Note that when you make a mistake and call a function that is supposed to be
|
|
5575 defined in an autoload script, but the script doesn't actually define the
|
|
5576 function, the script will be sourced every time you try to call the function.
|
168
|
5577 And you will get an error message every time.
|
|
5578
|
|
5579 Also note that if you have two script files, and one calls a function in the
|
|
5580 other and vise versa, before the used function is defined, it won't work.
|
|
5581 Avoid using the autoload functionality at the toplevel.
|
161
|
5582
|
794
|
5583 Hint: If you distribute a bunch of scripts you can pack them together with the
|
|
5584 |vimball| utility. Also read the user manual |distribute-script|.
|
|
5585
|
7
|
5586 ==============================================================================
|
|
5587 6. Curly braces names *curly-braces-names*
|
|
5588
|
|
5589 Wherever you can use a variable, you can use a "curly braces name" variable.
|
|
5590 This is a regular variable name with one or more expressions wrapped in braces
|
|
5591 {} like this: >
|
|
5592 my_{adjective}_variable
|
|
5593
|
|
5594 When Vim encounters this, it evaluates the expression inside the braces, puts
|
|
5595 that in place of the expression, and re-interprets the whole as a variable
|
|
5596 name. So in the above example, if the variable "adjective" was set to
|
|
5597 "noisy", then the reference would be to "my_noisy_variable", whereas if
|
|
5598 "adjective" was set to "quiet", then it would be to "my_quiet_variable".
|
|
5599
|
|
5600 One application for this is to create a set of variables governed by an option
|
|
5601 value. For example, the statement >
|
|
5602 echo my_{&background}_message
|
|
5603
|
|
5604 would output the contents of "my_dark_message" or "my_light_message" depending
|
|
5605 on the current value of 'background'.
|
|
5606
|
|
5607 You can use multiple brace pairs: >
|
|
5608 echo my_{adverb}_{adjective}_message
|
|
5609 ..or even nest them: >
|
|
5610 echo my_{ad{end_of_word}}_message
|
|
5611 where "end_of_word" is either "verb" or "jective".
|
|
5612
|
|
5613 However, the expression inside the braces must evaluate to a valid single
|
236
|
5614 variable name, e.g. this is invalid: >
|
7
|
5615 :let foo='a + b'
|
|
5616 :echo c{foo}d
|
|
5617 .. since the result of expansion is "ca + bd", which is not a variable name.
|
|
5618
|
|
5619 *curly-braces-function-names*
|
|
5620 You can call and define functions by an evaluated name in a similar way.
|
|
5621 Example: >
|
|
5622 :let func_end='whizz'
|
|
5623 :call my_func_{func_end}(parameter)
|
|
5624
|
|
5625 This would call the function "my_func_whizz(parameter)".
|
|
5626
|
|
5627 ==============================================================================
|
|
5628 7. Commands *expression-commands*
|
|
5629
|
|
5630 :let {var-name} = {expr1} *:let* *E18*
|
|
5631 Set internal variable {var-name} to the result of the
|
|
5632 expression {expr1}. The variable will get the type
|
|
5633 from the {expr}. If {var-name} didn't exist yet, it
|
|
5634 is created.
|
|
5635
|
85
|
5636 :let {var-name}[{idx}] = {expr1} *E689*
|
|
5637 Set a list item to the result of the expression
|
|
5638 {expr1}. {var-name} must refer to a list and {idx}
|
|
5639 must be a valid index in that list. For nested list
|
|
5640 the index can be repeated.
|
|
5641 This cannot be used to add an item to a list.
|
|
5642
|
114
|
5643 *E711* *E719*
|
|
5644 :let {var-name}[{idx1}:{idx2}] = {expr1} *E708* *E709* *E710*
|
685
|
5645 Set a sequence of items in a |List| to the result of
|
|
5646 the expression {expr1}, which must be a list with the
|
87
|
5647 correct number of items.
|
|
5648 {idx1} can be omitted, zero is used instead.
|
|
5649 {idx2} can be omitted, meaning the end of the list.
|
|
5650 When the selected range of items is partly past the
|
|
5651 end of the list, items will be added.
|
|
5652
|
153
|
5653 *:let+=* *:let-=* *:let.=* *E734*
|
114
|
5654 :let {var} += {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} + {expr1}".
|
|
5655 :let {var} -= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} - {expr1}".
|
|
5656 :let {var} .= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} . {expr1}".
|
|
5657 These fail if {var} was not set yet and when the type
|
|
5658 of {var} and {expr1} don't fit the operator.
|
|
5659
|
|
5660
|
7
|
5661 :let ${env-name} = {expr1} *:let-environment* *:let-$*
|
|
5662 Set environment variable {env-name} to the result of
|
|
5663 the expression {expr1}. The type is always String.
|
114
|
5664 :let ${env-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5665 Append {expr1} to the environment variable {env-name}.
|
|
5666 If the environment variable didn't exist yet this
|
|
5667 works like "=".
|
7
|
5668
|
|
5669 :let @{reg-name} = {expr1} *:let-register* *:let-@*
|
|
5670 Write the result of the expression {expr1} in register
|
|
5671 {reg-name}. {reg-name} must be a single letter, and
|
|
5672 must be the name of a writable register (see
|
|
5673 |registers|). "@@" can be used for the unnamed
|
|
5674 register, "@/" for the search pattern.
|
|
5675 If the result of {expr1} ends in a <CR> or <NL>, the
|
|
5676 register will be linewise, otherwise it will be set to
|
|
5677 characterwise.
|
|
5678 This can be used to clear the last search pattern: >
|
|
5679 :let @/ = ""
|
|
5680 < This is different from searching for an empty string,
|
|
5681 that would match everywhere.
|
|
5682
|
114
|
5683 :let @{reg-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5684 Append {expr1} to register {reg-name}. If the
|
|
5685 register was empty it's like setting it to {expr1}.
|
|
5686
|
7
|
5687 :let &{option-name} = {expr1} *:let-option* *:let-star*
|
|
5688 Set option {option-name} to the result of the
|
68
|
5689 expression {expr1}. A String or Number value is
|
|
5690 always converted to the type of the option.
|
7
|
5691 For an option local to a window or buffer the effect
|
|
5692 is just like using the |:set| command: both the local
|
555
|
5693 value and the global value are changed.
|
68
|
5694 Example: >
|
|
5695 :let &path = &path . ',/usr/local/include'
|
7
|
5696
|
114
|
5697 :let &{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5698 For a string option: Append {expr1} to the value.
|
|
5699 Does not insert a comma like |:set+=|.
|
|
5700
|
|
5701 :let &{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5702 :let &{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
|
5703 For a number or boolean option: Add or subtract
|
|
5704 {expr1}.
|
|
5705
|
7
|
5706 :let &l:{option-name} = {expr1}
|
114
|
5707 :let &l:{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5708 :let &l:{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5709 :let &l:{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
7
|
5710 Like above, but only set the local value of an option
|
|
5711 (if there is one). Works like |:setlocal|.
|
|
5712
|
|
5713 :let &g:{option-name} = {expr1}
|
114
|
5714 :let &g:{option-name} .= {expr1}
|
|
5715 :let &g:{option-name} += {expr1}
|
|
5716 :let &g:{option-name} -= {expr1}
|
7
|
5717 Like above, but only set the global value of an option
|
|
5718 (if there is one). Works like |:setglobal|.
|
|
5719
|
85
|
5720 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] = {expr1} *:let-unpack* *E687* *E688*
|
685
|
5721 {expr1} must evaluate to a |List|. The first item in
|
68
|
5722 the list is assigned to {name1}, the second item to
|
|
5723 {name2}, etc.
|
|
5724 The number of names must match the number of items in
|
685
|
5725 the |List|.
|
68
|
5726 Each name can be one of the items of the ":let"
|
|
5727 command as mentioned above.
|
|
5728 Example: >
|
|
5729 :let [s, item] = GetItem(s)
|
114
|
5730 < Detail: {expr1} is evaluated first, then the
|
|
5731 assignments are done in sequence. This matters if
|
|
5732 {name2} depends on {name1}. Example: >
|
|
5733 :let x = [0, 1]
|
|
5734 :let i = 0
|
|
5735 :let [i, x[i]] = [1, 2]
|
|
5736 :echo x
|
|
5737 < The result is [0, 2].
|
|
5738
|
|
5739 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] .= {expr1}
|
|
5740 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] += {expr1}
|
|
5741 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] -= {expr1}
|
|
5742 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
|
685
|
5743 |List| item.
|
68
|
5744
|
|
5745 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] = {expr1}
|
685
|
5746 Like |:let-unpack| above, but the |List| may have more
|
114
|
5747 items than there are names. A list of the remaining
|
|
5748 items is assigned to {lastname}. If there are no
|
|
5749 remaining items {lastname} is set to an empty list.
|
68
|
5750 Example: >
|
|
5751 :let [a, b; rest] = ["aval", "bval", 3, 4]
|
|
5752 <
|
114
|
5753 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] .= {expr1}
|
|
5754 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] += {expr1}
|
|
5755 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] -= {expr1}
|
|
5756 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
|
685
|
5757 |List| item.
|
7
|
5758 *E106*
|
114
|
5759 :let {var-name} .. List the value of variable {var-name}. Multiple
|
123
|
5760 variable names may be given. Special names recognized
|
|
5761 here: *E738*
|
777
|
5762 g: global variables
|
|
5763 b: local buffer variables
|
|
5764 w: local window variables
|
819
|
5765 t: local tab page variables
|
777
|
5766 s: script-local variables
|
|
5767 l: local function variables
|
123
|
5768 v: Vim variables.
|
7
|
5769
|
55
|
5770 :let List the values of all variables. The type of the
|
|
5771 variable is indicated before the value:
|
|
5772 <nothing> String
|
|
5773 # Number
|
856
|
5774 * Funcref
|
7
|
5775
|
148
|
5776
|
|
5777 :unl[et][!] {name} ... *:unlet* *:unl* *E108*
|
|
5778 Remove the internal variable {name}. Several variable
|
|
5779 names can be given, they are all removed. The name
|
685
|
5780 may also be a |List| or |Dictionary| item.
|
7
|
5781 With [!] no error message is given for non-existing
|
|
5782 variables.
|
685
|
5783 One or more items from a |List| can be removed: >
|
108
|
5784 :unlet list[3] " remove fourth item
|
|
5785 :unlet list[3:] " remove fourth item to last
|
685
|
5786 < One item from a |Dictionary| can be removed at a time: >
|
108
|
5787 :unlet dict['two']
|
|
5788 :unlet dict.two
|
7
|
5789
|
148
|
5790 :lockv[ar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:lockvar* *:lockv*
|
|
5791 Lock the internal variable {name}. Locking means that
|
|
5792 it can no longer be changed (until it is unlocked).
|
|
5793 A locked variable can be deleted: >
|
|
5794 :lockvar v
|
|
5795 :let v = 'asdf' " fails!
|
|
5796 :unlet v
|
|
5797 < *E741*
|
|
5798 If you try to change a locked variable you get an
|
|
5799 error message: "E741: Value of {name} is locked"
|
|
5800
|
685
|
5801 [depth] is relevant when locking a |List| or
|
|
5802 |Dictionary|. It specifies how deep the locking goes:
|
|
5803 1 Lock the |List| or |Dictionary| itself,
|
148
|
5804 cannot add or remove items, but can
|
|
5805 still change their values.
|
|
5806 2 Also lock the values, cannot change
|
685
|
5807 the items. If an item is a |List| or
|
|
5808 |Dictionary|, cannot add or remove
|
148
|
5809 items, but can still change the
|
|
5810 values.
|
685
|
5811 3 Like 2 but for the |List| /
|
|
5812 |Dictionary| in the |List| /
|
|
5813 |Dictionary|, one level deeper.
|
|
5814 The default [depth] is 2, thus when {name} is a |List|
|
|
5815 or |Dictionary| the values cannot be changed.
|
148
|
5816 *E743*
|
|
5817 For unlimited depth use [!] and omit [depth].
|
|
5818 However, there is a maximum depth of 100 to catch
|
|
5819 loops.
|
|
5820
|
685
|
5821 Note that when two variables refer to the same |List|
|
|
5822 and you lock one of them, the |List| will also be
|
819
|
5823 locked when used through the other variable.
|
|
5824 Example: >
|
148
|
5825 :let l = [0, 1, 2, 3]
|
|
5826 :let cl = l
|
|
5827 :lockvar l
|
|
5828 :let cl[1] = 99 " won't work!
|
|
5829 < You may want to make a copy of a list to avoid this.
|
|
5830 See |deepcopy()|.
|
|
5831
|
|
5832
|
|
5833 :unlo[ckvar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:unlockvar* *:unlo*
|
|
5834 Unlock the internal variable {name}. Does the
|
|
5835 opposite of |:lockvar|.
|
|
5836
|
|
5837
|
7
|
5838 :if {expr1} *:if* *:endif* *:en* *E171* *E579* *E580*
|
|
5839 :en[dif] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
|
|
5840 or ":endif" if {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
|
|
5841
|
|
5842 From Vim version 4.5 until 5.0, every Ex command in
|
|
5843 between the ":if" and ":endif" is ignored. These two
|
|
5844 commands were just to allow for future expansions in a
|
|
5845 backwards compatible way. Nesting was allowed. Note
|
|
5846 that any ":else" or ":elseif" was ignored, the "else"
|
|
5847 part was not executed either.
|
|
5848
|
|
5849 You can use this to remain compatible with older
|
|
5850 versions: >
|
|
5851 :if version >= 500
|
|
5852 : version-5-specific-commands
|
|
5853 :endif
|
|
5854 < The commands still need to be parsed to find the
|
|
5855 "endif". Sometimes an older Vim has a problem with a
|
|
5856 new command. For example, ":silent" is recognized as
|
|
5857 a ":substitute" command. In that case ":execute" can
|
|
5858 avoid problems: >
|
|
5859 :if version >= 600
|
|
5860 : execute "silent 1,$delete"
|
|
5861 :endif
|
|
5862 <
|
|
5863 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
|
|
5864 properly in between ":if" and ":endif".
|
|
5865
|
|
5866 *:else* *:el* *E581* *E583*
|
|
5867 :el[se] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
|
|
5868 or ":endif" if they previously were not being
|
|
5869 executed.
|
|
5870
|
|
5871 *:elseif* *:elsei* *E582* *E584*
|
|
5872 :elsei[f] {expr1} Short for ":else" ":if", with the addition that there
|
|
5873 is no extra ":endif".
|
|
5874
|
|
5875 :wh[ile] {expr1} *:while* *:endwhile* *:wh* *:endw*
|
114
|
5876 *E170* *E585* *E588* *E733*
|
7
|
5877 :endw[hile] Repeat the commands between ":while" and ":endwhile",
|
|
5878 as long as {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
|
|
5879 When an error is detected from a command inside the
|
|
5880 loop, execution continues after the "endwhile".
|
75
|
5881 Example: >
|
|
5882 :let lnum = 1
|
|
5883 :while lnum <= line("$")
|
|
5884 :call FixLine(lnum)
|
|
5885 :let lnum = lnum + 1
|
|
5886 :endwhile
|
|
5887 <
|
7
|
5888 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
|
99
|
5889 properly inside a ":while" and ":for" loop.
|
75
|
5890
|
114
|
5891 :for {var} in {list} *:for* *E690* *E732*
|
75
|
5892 :endfo[r] *:endfo* *:endfor*
|
|
5893 Repeat the commands between ":for" and ":endfor" for
|
158
|
5894 each item in {list}. Variable {var} is set to the
|
79
|
5895 value of each item.
|
|
5896 When an error is detected for a command inside the
|
75
|
5897 loop, execution continues after the "endfor".
|
464
|
5898 Changing {list} inside the loop affects what items are
|
|
5899 used. Make a copy if this is unwanted: >
|
79
|
5900 :for item in copy(mylist)
|
|
5901 < When not making a copy, Vim stores a reference to the
|
|
5902 next item in the list, before executing the commands
|
|
5903 with the current item. Thus the current item can be
|
|
5904 removed without effect. Removing any later item means
|
|
5905 it will not be found. Thus the following example
|
|
5906 works (an inefficient way to make a list empty): >
|
|
5907 :for item in mylist
|
75
|
5908 :call remove(mylist, 0)
|
|
5909 :endfor
|
87
|
5910 < Note that reordering the list (e.g., with sort() or
|
|
5911 reverse()) may have unexpected effects.
|
|
5912 Note that the type of each list item should be
|
75
|
5913 identical to avoid errors for the type of {var}
|
|
5914 changing. Unlet the variable at the end of the loop
|
|
5915 to allow multiple item types.
|
|
5916
|
|
5917 :for [{var1}, {var2}, ...] in {listlist}
|
|
5918 :endfo[r]
|
|
5919 Like ":for" above, but each item in {listlist} must be
|
|
5920 a list, of which each item is assigned to {var1},
|
|
5921 {var2}, etc. Example: >
|
|
5922 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 5], [3, 8]]
|
|
5923 :echo getline(lnum)[col]
|
|
5924 :endfor
|
|
5925 <
|
7
|
5926 *:continue* *:con* *E586*
|
75
|
5927 :con[tinue] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, jumps back
|
|
5928 to the start of the loop.
|
|
5929 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
|
|
5930 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
|
|
5931 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
|
|
5932 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
|
|
5933 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
|
|
5934 ":endtry" then jumps back to the start of the loop.
|
7
|
5935
|
|
5936 *:break* *:brea* *E587*
|
75
|
5937 :brea[k] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, skips to
|
|
5938 the command after the matching ":endwhile" or
|
|
5939 ":endfor".
|
|
5940 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
|
|
5941 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
|
|
5942 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
|
|
5943 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
|
|
5944 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
|
|
5945 ":endtry" then jumps to the command after the loop.
|
7
|
5946
|
|
5947 :try *:try* *:endt* *:endtry* *E600* *E601* *E602*
|
|
5948 :endt[ry] Change the error handling for the commands between
|
|
5949 ":try" and ":endtry" including everything being
|
|
5950 executed across ":source" commands, function calls,
|
|
5951 or autocommand invocations.
|
|
5952
|
|
5953 When an error or interrupt is detected and there is
|
|
5954 a |:finally| command following, execution continues
|
|
5955 after the ":finally". Otherwise, or when the
|
|
5956 ":endtry" is reached thereafter, the next
|
|
5957 (dynamically) surrounding ":try" is checked for
|
|
5958 a corresponding ":finally" etc. Then the script
|
|
5959 processing is terminated. (Whether a function
|
|
5960 definition has an "abort" argument does not matter.)
|
|
5961 Example: >
|
|
5962 :try | edit too much | finally | echo "cleanup" | endtry
|
|
5963 :echo "impossible" " not reached, script terminated above
|
|
5964 <
|
|
5965 Moreover, an error or interrupt (dynamically) inside
|
|
5966 ":try" and ":endtry" is converted to an exception. It
|
|
5967 can be caught as if it were thrown by a |:throw|
|
|
5968 command (see |:catch|). In this case, the script
|
|
5969 processing is not terminated.
|
|
5970
|
|
5971 The value "Vim:Interrupt" is used for an interrupt
|
|
5972 exception. An error in a Vim command is converted
|
|
5973 to a value of the form "Vim({command}):{errmsg}",
|
|
5974 other errors are converted to a value of the form
|
|
5975 "Vim:{errmsg}". {command} is the full command name,
|
|
5976 and {errmsg} is the message that is displayed if the
|
|
5977 error exception is not caught, always beginning with
|
|
5978 the error number.
|
|
5979 Examples: >
|
|
5980 :try | sleep 100 | catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | endtry
|
|
5981 :try | edit | catch /^Vim(edit):E\d\+/ | echo "error" | endtry
|
|
5982 <
|
|
5983 *:cat* *:catch* *E603* *E604* *E605*
|
|
5984 :cat[ch] /{pattern}/ The following commands until the next ":catch",
|
|
5985 |:finally|, or |:endtry| that belongs to the same
|
|
5986 |:try| as the ":catch" are executed when an exception
|
|
5987 matching {pattern} is being thrown and has not yet
|
|
5988 been caught by a previous ":catch". Otherwise, these
|
|
5989 commands are skipped.
|
|
5990 When {pattern} is omitted all errors are caught.
|
|
5991 Examples: >
|
|
5992 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ " catch interrupts (CTRL-C)
|
|
5993 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E/ " catch all Vim errors
|
|
5994 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:/ " catch errors and interrupts
|
|
5995 :catch /^Vim(write):/ " catch all errors in :write
|
|
5996 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E123/ " catch error E123
|
|
5997 :catch /my-exception/ " catch user exception
|
|
5998 :catch /.*/ " catch everything
|
|
5999 :catch " same as /.*/
|
|
6000 <
|
|
6001 Another character can be used instead of / around the
|
|
6002 {pattern}, so long as it does not have a special
|
|
6003 meaning (e.g., '|' or '"') and doesn't occur inside
|
|
6004 {pattern}.
|
|
6005 NOTE: It is not reliable to ":catch" the TEXT of
|
|
6006 an error message because it may vary in different
|
|
6007 locales.
|
|
6008
|
|
6009 *:fina* *:finally* *E606* *E607*
|
|
6010 :fina[lly] The following commands until the matching |:endtry|
|
|
6011 are executed whenever the part between the matching
|
|
6012 |:try| and the ":finally" is left: either by falling
|
|
6013 through to the ":finally" or by a |:continue|,
|
|
6014 |:break|, |:finish|, or |:return|, or by an error or
|
|
6015 interrupt or exception (see |:throw|).
|
|
6016
|
|
6017 *:th* *:throw* *E608*
|
|
6018 :th[row] {expr1} The {expr1} is evaluated and thrown as an exception.
|
|
6019 If the ":throw" is used after a |:try| but before the
|
|
6020 first corresponding |:catch|, commands are skipped
|
|
6021 until the first ":catch" matching {expr1} is reached.
|
|
6022 If there is no such ":catch" or if the ":throw" is
|
|
6023 used after a ":catch" but before the |:finally|, the
|
|
6024 commands following the ":finally" (if present) up to
|
|
6025 the matching |:endtry| are executed. If the ":throw"
|
|
6026 is after the ":finally", commands up to the ":endtry"
|
|
6027 are skipped. At the ":endtry", this process applies
|
|
6028 again for the next dynamically surrounding ":try"
|
|
6029 (which may be found in a calling function or sourcing
|
|
6030 script), until a matching ":catch" has been found.
|
|
6031 If the exception is not caught, the command processing
|
|
6032 is terminated.
|
|
6033 Example: >
|
|
6034 :try | throw "oops" | catch /^oo/ | echo "caught" | endtry
|
|
6035 <
|
|
6036
|
|
6037 *:ec* *:echo*
|
|
6038 :ec[ho] {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, with a space in between. The
|
|
6039 first {expr1} starts on a new line.
|
|
6040 Also see |:comment|.
|
|
6041 Use "\n" to start a new line. Use "\r" to move the
|
|
6042 cursor to the first column.
|
|
6043 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6044 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6045 Example: >
|
|
6046 :echo "the value of 'shell' is" &shell
|
|
6047 < A later redraw may make the message disappear again.
|
|
6048 To avoid that a command from before the ":echo" causes
|
|
6049 a redraw afterwards (redraws are often postponed until
|
|
6050 you type something), force a redraw with the |:redraw|
|
|
6051 command. Example: >
|
|
6052 :new | redraw | echo "there is a new window"
|
|
6053 <
|
|
6054 *:echon*
|
|
6055 :echon {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, without anything added. Also see
|
|
6056 |:comment|.
|
|
6057 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6058 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6059 Example: >
|
|
6060 :echon "the value of 'shell' is " &shell
|
|
6061 <
|
|
6062 Note the difference between using ":echo", which is a
|
|
6063 Vim command, and ":!echo", which is an external shell
|
|
6064 command: >
|
|
6065 :!echo % --> filename
|
|
6066 < The arguments of ":!" are expanded, see |:_%|. >
|
|
6067 :!echo "%" --> filename or "filename"
|
|
6068 < Like the previous example. Whether you see the double
|
|
6069 quotes or not depends on your 'shell'. >
|
|
6070 :echo % --> nothing
|
|
6071 < The '%' is an illegal character in an expression. >
|
|
6072 :echo "%" --> %
|
|
6073 < This just echoes the '%' character. >
|
|
6074 :echo expand("%") --> filename
|
|
6075 < This calls the expand() function to expand the '%'.
|
|
6076
|
|
6077 *:echoh* *:echohl*
|
|
6078 :echoh[l] {name} Use the highlight group {name} for the following
|
|
6079 |:echo|, |:echon| and |:echomsg| commands. Also used
|
|
6080 for the |input()| prompt. Example: >
|
|
6081 :echohl WarningMsg | echo "Don't panic!" | echohl None
|
|
6082 < Don't forget to set the group back to "None",
|
|
6083 otherwise all following echo's will be highlighted.
|
|
6084
|
|
6085 *:echom* *:echomsg*
|
|
6086 :echom[sg] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as a true message, saving the
|
|
6087 message in the |message-history|.
|
|
6088 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
|
|
6089 |:echo| command. But unprintable characters are
|
|
6090 displayed, not interpreted.
|
|
6091 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
|
|
6092 Example: >
|
|
6093 :echomsg "It's a Zizzer Zazzer Zuzz, as you can plainly see."
|
|
6094 <
|
|
6095 *:echoe* *:echoerr*
|
|
6096 :echoe[rr] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as an error message, saving the
|
|
6097 message in the |message-history|. When used in a
|
|
6098 script or function the line number will be added.
|
|
6099 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
|
|
6100 :echo command. When used inside a try conditional,
|
|
6101 the message is raised as an error exception instead
|
|
6102 (see |try-echoerr|).
|
|
6103 Example: >
|
|
6104 :echoerr "This script just failed!"
|
|
6105 < If you just want a highlighted message use |:echohl|.
|
|
6106 And to get a beep: >
|
|
6107 :exe "normal \<Esc>"
|
|
6108 <
|
|
6109 *:exe* *:execute*
|
|
6110 :exe[cute] {expr1} .. Executes the string that results from the evaluation
|
|
6111 of {expr1} as an Ex command. Multiple arguments are
|
|
6112 concatenated, with a space in between. {expr1} is
|
|
6113 used as the processed command, command line editing
|
|
6114 keys are not recognized.
|
|
6115 Cannot be followed by a comment.
|
|
6116 Examples: >
|
|
6117 :execute "buffer " nextbuf
|
|
6118 :execute "normal " count . "w"
|
|
6119 <
|
|
6120 ":execute" can be used to append a command to commands
|
|
6121 that don't accept a '|'. Example: >
|
|
6122 :execute '!ls' | echo "theend"
|
|
6123
|
|
6124 < ":execute" is also a nice way to avoid having to type
|
|
6125 control characters in a Vim script for a ":normal"
|
|
6126 command: >
|
|
6127 :execute "normal ixxx\<Esc>"
|
|
6128 < This has an <Esc> character, see |expr-string|.
|
|
6129
|
|
6130 Note: The executed string may be any command-line, but
|
99
|
6131 you cannot start or end a "while", "for" or "if"
|
|
6132 command. Thus this is illegal: >
|
7
|
6133 :execute 'while i > 5'
|
|
6134 :execute 'echo "test" | break'
|
|
6135 <
|
|
6136 It is allowed to have a "while" or "if" command
|
|
6137 completely in the executed string: >
|
|
6138 :execute 'while i < 5 | echo i | let i = i + 1 | endwhile'
|
|
6139 <
|
|
6140
|
|
6141 *:comment*
|
|
6142 ":execute", ":echo" and ":echon" cannot be followed by
|
|
6143 a comment directly, because they see the '"' as the
|
|
6144 start of a string. But, you can use '|' followed by a
|
|
6145 comment. Example: >
|
|
6146 :echo "foo" | "this is a comment
|
|
6147
|
|
6148 ==============================================================================
|
|
6149 8. Exception handling *exception-handling*
|
|
6150
|
|
6151 The Vim script language comprises an exception handling feature. This section
|
|
6152 explains how it can be used in a Vim script.
|
|
6153
|
|
6154 Exceptions may be raised by Vim on an error or on interrupt, see
|
|
6155 |catch-errors| and |catch-interrupt|. You can also explicitly throw an
|
|
6156 exception by using the ":throw" command, see |throw-catch|.
|
|
6157
|
|
6158
|
|
6159 TRY CONDITIONALS *try-conditionals*
|
|
6160
|
|
6161 Exceptions can be caught or can cause cleanup code to be executed. You can
|
|
6162 use a try conditional to specify catch clauses (that catch exceptions) and/or
|
|
6163 a finally clause (to be executed for cleanup).
|
|
6164 A try conditional begins with a |:try| command and ends at the matching
|
|
6165 |:endtry| command. In between, you can use a |:catch| command to start
|
|
6166 a catch clause, or a |:finally| command to start a finally clause. There may
|
|
6167 be none or multiple catch clauses, but there is at most one finally clause,
|
|
6168 which must not be followed by any catch clauses. The lines before the catch
|
|
6169 clauses and the finally clause is called a try block. >
|
|
6170
|
|
6171 :try
|
|
6172 : ...
|
|
6173 : ... TRY BLOCK
|
|
6174 : ...
|
|
6175 :catch /{pattern}/
|
|
6176 : ...
|
|
6177 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
|
|
6178 : ...
|
|
6179 :catch /{pattern}/
|
|
6180 : ...
|
|
6181 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
|
|
6182 : ...
|
|
6183 :finally
|
|
6184 : ...
|
|
6185 : ... FINALLY CLAUSE
|
|
6186 : ...
|
|
6187 :endtry
|
|
6188
|
|
6189 The try conditional allows to watch code for exceptions and to take the
|
|
6190 appropriate actions. Exceptions from the try block may be caught. Exceptions
|
|
6191 from the try block and also the catch clauses may cause cleanup actions.
|
|
6192 When no exception is thrown during execution of the try block, the control
|
|
6193 is transferred to the finally clause, if present. After its execution, the
|
|
6194 script continues with the line following the ":endtry".
|
|
6195 When an exception occurs during execution of the try block, the remaining
|
|
6196 lines in the try block are skipped. The exception is matched against the
|
|
6197 patterns specified as arguments to the ":catch" commands. The catch clause
|
|
6198 after the first matching ":catch" is taken, other catch clauses are not
|
|
6199 executed. The catch clause ends when the next ":catch", ":finally", or
|
|
6200 ":endtry" command is reached - whatever is first. Then, the finally clause
|
|
6201 (if present) is executed. When the ":endtry" is reached, the script execution
|
|
6202 continues in the following line as usual.
|
|
6203 When an exception that does not match any of the patterns specified by the
|
|
6204 ":catch" commands is thrown in the try block, the exception is not caught by
|
|
6205 that try conditional and none of the catch clauses is executed. Only the
|
|
6206 finally clause, if present, is taken. The exception pends during execution of
|
|
6207 the finally clause. It is resumed at the ":endtry", so that commands after
|
|
6208 the ":endtry" are not executed and the exception might be caught elsewhere,
|
|
6209 see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6210 When during execution of a catch clause another exception is thrown, the
|
|
6211 remaining lines in that catch clause are not executed. The new exception is
|
|
6212 not matched against the patterns in any of the ":catch" commands of the same
|
|
6213 try conditional and none of its catch clauses is taken. If there is, however,
|
|
6214 a finally clause, it is executed, and the exception pends during its
|
|
6215 execution. The commands following the ":endtry" are not executed. The new
|
|
6216 exception might, however, be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6217 When during execution of the finally clause (if present) an exception is
|
|
6218 thrown, the remaining lines in the finally clause are skipped. If the finally
|
|
6219 clause has been taken because of an exception from the try block or one of the
|
|
6220 catch clauses, the original (pending) exception is discarded. The commands
|
|
6221 following the ":endtry" are not executed, and the exception from the finally
|
|
6222 clause is propagated and can be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
|
|
6223
|
|
6224 The finally clause is also executed, when a ":break" or ":continue" for
|
|
6225 a ":while" loop enclosing the complete try conditional is executed from the
|
|
6226 try block or a catch clause. Or when a ":return" or ":finish" is executed
|
|
6227 from the try block or a catch clause of a try conditional in a function or
|
|
6228 sourced script, respectively. The ":break", ":continue", ":return", or
|
|
6229 ":finish" pends during execution of the finally clause and is resumed when the
|
|
6230 ":endtry" is reached. It is, however, discarded when an exception is thrown
|
|
6231 from the finally clause.
|
|
6232 When a ":break" or ":continue" for a ":while" loop enclosing the complete
|
|
6233 try conditional or when a ":return" or ":finish" is encountered in the finally
|
|
6234 clause, the rest of the finally clause is skipped, and the ":break",
|
|
6235 ":continue", ":return" or ":finish" is executed as usual. If the finally
|
|
6236 clause has been taken because of an exception or an earlier ":break",
|
|
6237 ":continue", ":return", or ":finish" from the try block or a catch clause,
|
|
6238 this pending exception or command is discarded.
|
|
6239
|
|
6240 For examples see |throw-catch| and |try-finally|.
|
|
6241
|
|
6242
|
|
6243 NESTING OF TRY CONDITIONALS *try-nesting*
|
|
6244
|
|
6245 Try conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. That is, a complete try
|
|
6246 conditional can be put into the try block, a catch clause, or the finally
|
|
6247 clause of another try conditional. If the inner try conditional does not
|
|
6248 catch an exception thrown in its try block or throws a new exception from one
|
|
6249 of its catch clauses or its finally clause, the outer try conditional is
|
|
6250 checked according to the rules above. If the inner try conditional is in the
|
|
6251 try block of the outer try conditional, its catch clauses are checked, but
|
|
6252 otherwise only the finally clause is executed. It does not matter for
|
|
6253 nesting, whether the inner try conditional is directly contained in the outer
|
|
6254 one, or whether the outer one sources a script or calls a function containing
|
|
6255 the inner try conditional.
|
|
6256
|
|
6257 When none of the active try conditionals catches an exception, just their
|
|
6258 finally clauses are executed. Thereafter, the script processing terminates.
|
|
6259 An error message is displayed in case of an uncaught exception explicitly
|
|
6260 thrown by a ":throw" command. For uncaught error and interrupt exceptions
|
|
6261 implicitly raised by Vim, the error message(s) or interrupt message are shown
|
|
6262 as usual.
|
|
6263
|
|
6264 For examples see |throw-catch|.
|
|
6265
|
|
6266
|
|
6267 EXAMINING EXCEPTION HANDLING CODE *except-examine*
|
|
6268
|
|
6269 Exception handling code can get tricky. If you are in doubt what happens, set
|
|
6270 'verbose' to 13 or use the ":13verbose" command modifier when sourcing your
|
|
6271 script file. Then you see when an exception is thrown, discarded, caught, or
|
|
6272 finished. When using a verbosity level of at least 14, things pending in
|
|
6273 a finally clause are also shown. This information is also given in debug mode
|
|
6274 (see |debug-scripts|).
|
|
6275
|
|
6276
|
|
6277 THROWING AND CATCHING EXCEPTIONS *throw-catch*
|
|
6278
|
|
6279 You can throw any number or string as an exception. Use the |:throw| command
|
|
6280 and pass the value to be thrown as argument: >
|
|
6281 :throw 4711
|
|
6282 :throw "string"
|
|
6283 < *throw-expression*
|
|
6284 You can also specify an expression argument. The expression is then evaluated
|
|
6285 first, and the result is thrown: >
|
|
6286 :throw 4705 + strlen("string")
|
|
6287 :throw strpart("strings", 0, 6)
|
|
6288
|
|
6289 An exception might be thrown during evaluation of the argument of the ":throw"
|
|
6290 command. Unless it is caught there, the expression evaluation is abandoned.
|
|
6291 The ":throw" command then does not throw a new exception.
|
|
6292 Example: >
|
|
6293
|
|
6294 :function! Foo(arg)
|
|
6295 : try
|
|
6296 : throw a:arg
|
|
6297 : catch /foo/
|
|
6298 : endtry
|
|
6299 : return 1
|
|
6300 :endfunction
|
|
6301 :
|
|
6302 :function! Bar()
|
|
6303 : echo "in Bar"
|
|
6304 : return 4710
|
|
6305 :endfunction
|
|
6306 :
|
|
6307 :throw Foo("arrgh") + Bar()
|
|
6308
|
|
6309 This throws "arrgh", and "in Bar" is not displayed since Bar() is not
|
|
6310 executed. >
|
|
6311 :throw Foo("foo") + Bar()
|
|
6312 however displays "in Bar" and throws 4711.
|
|
6313
|
|
6314 Any other command that takes an expression as argument might also be
|
|
6315 abandoned by an (uncaught) exception during the expression evaluation. The
|
|
6316 exception is then propagated to the caller of the command.
|
|
6317 Example: >
|
|
6318
|
|
6319 :if Foo("arrgh")
|
|
6320 : echo "then"
|
|
6321 :else
|
|
6322 : echo "else"
|
|
6323 :endif
|
|
6324
|
|
6325 Here neither of "then" or "else" is displayed.
|
|
6326
|
|
6327 *catch-order*
|
|
6328 Exceptions can be caught by a try conditional with one or more |:catch|
|
|
6329 commands, see |try-conditionals|. The values to be caught by each ":catch"
|
|
6330 command can be specified as a pattern argument. The subsequent catch clause
|
|
6331 gets executed when a matching exception is caught.
|
|
6332 Example: >
|
|
6333
|
|
6334 :function! Foo(value)
|
|
6335 : try
|
|
6336 : throw a:value
|
|
6337 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6338 : echo "Number thrown"
|
|
6339 : catch /.*/
|
|
6340 : echo "String thrown"
|
|
6341 : endtry
|
|
6342 :endfunction
|
|
6343 :
|
|
6344 :call Foo(0x1267)
|
|
6345 :call Foo('string')
|
|
6346
|
|
6347 The first call to Foo() displays "Number thrown", the second "String thrown".
|
|
6348 An exception is matched against the ":catch" commands in the order they are
|
|
6349 specified. Only the first match counts. So you should place the more
|
|
6350 specific ":catch" first. The following order does not make sense: >
|
|
6351
|
|
6352 : catch /.*/
|
|
6353 : echo "String thrown"
|
|
6354 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6355 : echo "Number thrown"
|
|
6356
|
|
6357 The first ":catch" here matches always, so that the second catch clause is
|
|
6358 never taken.
|
|
6359
|
|
6360 *throw-variables*
|
|
6361 If you catch an exception by a general pattern, you may access the exact value
|
|
6362 in the variable |v:exception|: >
|
|
6363
|
|
6364 : catch /^\d\+$/
|
|
6365 : echo "Number thrown. Value is" v:exception
|
|
6366
|
|
6367 You may also be interested where an exception was thrown. This is stored in
|
|
6368 |v:throwpoint|. Note that "v:exception" and "v:throwpoint" are valid for the
|
|
6369 exception most recently caught as long it is not finished.
|
|
6370 Example: >
|
|
6371
|
|
6372 :function! Caught()
|
|
6373 : if v:exception != ""
|
|
6374 : echo 'Caught "' . v:exception . '" in ' . v:throwpoint
|
|
6375 : else
|
|
6376 : echo 'Nothing caught'
|
|
6377 : endif
|
|
6378 :endfunction
|
|
6379 :
|
|
6380 :function! Foo()
|
|
6381 : try
|
|
6382 : try
|
|
6383 : try
|
|
6384 : throw 4711
|
|
6385 : finally
|
|
6386 : call Caught()
|
|
6387 : endtry
|
|
6388 : catch /.*/
|
|
6389 : call Caught()
|
|
6390 : throw "oops"
|
|
6391 : endtry
|
|
6392 : catch /.*/
|
|
6393 : call Caught()
|
|
6394 : finally
|
|
6395 : call Caught()
|
|
6396 : endtry
|
|
6397 :endfunction
|
|
6398 :
|
|
6399 :call Foo()
|
|
6400
|
|
6401 This displays >
|
|
6402
|
|
6403 Nothing caught
|
|
6404 Caught "4711" in function Foo, line 4
|
|
6405 Caught "oops" in function Foo, line 10
|
|
6406 Nothing caught
|
|
6407
|
|
6408 A practical example: The following command ":LineNumber" displays the line
|
|
6409 number in the script or function where it has been used: >
|
|
6410
|
|
6411 :function! LineNumber()
|
|
6412 : return substitute(v:throwpoint, '.*\D\(\d\+\).*', '\1', "")
|
|
6413 :endfunction
|
|
6414 :command! LineNumber try | throw "" | catch | echo LineNumber() | endtry
|
|
6415 <
|
|
6416 *try-nested*
|
|
6417 An exception that is not caught by a try conditional can be caught by
|
|
6418 a surrounding try conditional: >
|
|
6419
|
|
6420 :try
|
|
6421 : try
|
|
6422 : throw "foo"
|
|
6423 : catch /foobar/
|
|
6424 : echo "foobar"
|
|
6425 : finally
|
|
6426 : echo "inner finally"
|
|
6427 : endtry
|
|
6428 :catch /foo/
|
|
6429 : echo "foo"
|
|
6430 :endtry
|
|
6431
|
|
6432 The inner try conditional does not catch the exception, just its finally
|
|
6433 clause is executed. The exception is then caught by the outer try
|
|
6434 conditional. The example displays "inner finally" and then "foo".
|
|
6435
|
|
6436 *throw-from-catch*
|
|
6437 You can catch an exception and throw a new one to be caught elsewhere from the
|
|
6438 catch clause: >
|
|
6439
|
|
6440 :function! Foo()
|
|
6441 : throw "foo"
|
|
6442 :endfunction
|
|
6443 :
|
|
6444 :function! Bar()
|
|
6445 : try
|
|
6446 : call Foo()
|
|
6447 : catch /foo/
|
|
6448 : echo "Caught foo, throw bar"
|
|
6449 : throw "bar"
|
|
6450 : endtry
|
|
6451 :endfunction
|
|
6452 :
|
|
6453 :try
|
|
6454 : call Bar()
|
|
6455 :catch /.*/
|
|
6456 : echo "Caught" v:exception
|
|
6457 :endtry
|
|
6458
|
|
6459 This displays "Caught foo, throw bar" and then "Caught bar".
|
|
6460
|
|
6461 *rethrow*
|
|
6462 There is no real rethrow in the Vim script language, but you may throw
|
|
6463 "v:exception" instead: >
|
|
6464
|
|
6465 :function! Bar()
|
|
6466 : try
|
|
6467 : call Foo()
|
|
6468 : catch /.*/
|
|
6469 : echo "Rethrow" v:exception
|
|
6470 : throw v:exception
|
|
6471 : endtry
|
|
6472 :endfunction
|
|
6473 < *try-echoerr*
|
|
6474 Note that this method cannot be used to "rethrow" Vim error or interrupt
|
|
6475 exceptions, because it is not possible to fake Vim internal exceptions.
|
|
6476 Trying so causes an error exception. You should throw your own exception
|
|
6477 denoting the situation. If you want to cause a Vim error exception containing
|
|
6478 the original error exception value, you can use the |:echoerr| command: >
|
|
6479
|
|
6480 :try
|
|
6481 : try
|
|
6482 : asdf
|
|
6483 : catch /.*/
|
|
6484 : echoerr v:exception
|
|
6485 : endtry
|
|
6486 :catch /.*/
|
|
6487 : echo v:exception
|
|
6488 :endtry
|
|
6489
|
|
6490 This code displays
|
|
6491
|
|
6492 Vim(echoerr):Vim:E492: Not an editor command: asdf ~
|
|
6493
|
|
6494
|
|
6495 CLEANUP CODE *try-finally*
|
|
6496
|
|
6497 Scripts often change global settings and restore them at their end. If the
|
|
6498 user however interrupts the script by pressing CTRL-C, the settings remain in
|
|
6499 an inconsistent state. The same may happen to you in the development phase of
|
|
6500 a script when an error occurs or you explicitly throw an exception without
|
|
6501 catching it. You can solve these problems by using a try conditional with
|
|
6502 a finally clause for restoring the settings. Its execution is guaranteed on
|
|
6503 normal control flow, on error, on an explicit ":throw", and on interrupt.
|
|
6504 (Note that errors and interrupts from inside the try conditional are converted
|
|
6505 to exceptions. When not caught, they terminate the script after the finally
|
|
6506 clause has been executed.)
|
|
6507 Example: >
|
|
6508
|
|
6509 :try
|
|
6510 : let s:saved_ts = &ts
|
|
6511 : set ts=17
|
|
6512 :
|
|
6513 : " Do the hard work here.
|
|
6514 :
|
|
6515 :finally
|
|
6516 : let &ts = s:saved_ts
|
|
6517 : unlet s:saved_ts
|
|
6518 :endtry
|
|
6519
|
|
6520 This method should be used locally whenever a function or part of a script
|
|
6521 changes global settings which need to be restored on failure or normal exit of
|
|
6522 that function or script part.
|
|
6523
|
|
6524 *break-finally*
|
|
6525 Cleanup code works also when the try block or a catch clause is left by
|
|
6526 a ":continue", ":break", ":return", or ":finish".
|
|
6527 Example: >
|
|
6528
|
|
6529 :let first = 1
|
|
6530 :while 1
|
|
6531 : try
|
|
6532 : if first
|
|
6533 : echo "first"
|
|
6534 : let first = 0
|
|
6535 : continue
|
|
6536 : else
|
|
6537 : throw "second"
|
|
6538 : endif
|
|
6539 : catch /.*/
|
|
6540 : echo v:exception
|
|
6541 : break
|
|
6542 : finally
|
|
6543 : echo "cleanup"
|
|
6544 : endtry
|
|
6545 : echo "still in while"
|
|
6546 :endwhile
|
|
6547 :echo "end"
|
|
6548
|
|
6549 This displays "first", "cleanup", "second", "cleanup", and "end". >
|
|
6550
|
|
6551 :function! Foo()
|
|
6552 : try
|
|
6553 : return 4711
|
|
6554 : finally
|
|
6555 : echo "cleanup\n"
|
|
6556 : endtry
|
|
6557 : echo "Foo still active"
|
|
6558 :endfunction
|
|
6559 :
|
|
6560 :echo Foo() "returned by Foo"
|
|
6561
|
|
6562 This displays "cleanup" and "4711 returned by Foo". You don't need to add an
|
|
6563 extra ":return" in the finally clause. (Above all, this would override the
|
|
6564 return value.)
|
|
6565
|
|
6566 *except-from-finally*
|
|
6567 Using either of ":continue", ":break", ":return", ":finish", or ":throw" in
|
|
6568 a finally clause is possible, but not recommended since it abandons the
|
|
6569 cleanup actions for the try conditional. But, of course, interrupt and error
|
|
6570 exceptions might get raised from a finally clause.
|
|
6571 Example where an error in the finally clause stops an interrupt from
|
|
6572 working correctly: >
|
|
6573
|
|
6574 :try
|
|
6575 : try
|
|
6576 : echo "Press CTRL-C for interrupt"
|
|
6577 : while 1
|
|
6578 : endwhile
|
|
6579 : finally
|
|
6580 : unlet novar
|
|
6581 : endtry
|
|
6582 :catch /novar/
|
|
6583 :endtry
|
|
6584 :echo "Script still running"
|
|
6585 :sleep 1
|
|
6586
|
|
6587 If you need to put commands that could fail into a finally clause, you should
|
|
6588 think about catching or ignoring the errors in these commands, see
|
|
6589 |catch-errors| and |ignore-errors|.
|
|
6590
|
|
6591
|
|
6592 CATCHING ERRORS *catch-errors*
|
|
6593
|
|
6594 If you want to catch specific errors, you just have to put the code to be
|
|
6595 watched in a try block and add a catch clause for the error message. The
|
|
6596 presence of the try conditional causes all errors to be converted to an
|
|
6597 exception. No message is displayed and |v:errmsg| is not set then. To find
|
|
6598 the right pattern for the ":catch" command, you have to know how the format of
|
|
6599 the error exception is.
|
|
6600 Error exceptions have the following format: >
|
|
6601
|
|
6602 Vim({cmdname}):{errmsg}
|
|
6603 or >
|
|
6604 Vim:{errmsg}
|
|
6605
|
|
6606 {cmdname} is the name of the command that failed; the second form is used when
|
|
6607 the command name is not known. {errmsg} is the error message usually produced
|
|
6608 when the error occurs outside try conditionals. It always begins with
|
|
6609 a capital "E", followed by a two or three-digit error number, a colon, and
|
|
6610 a space.
|
|
6611
|
|
6612 Examples:
|
|
6613
|
|
6614 The command >
|
|
6615 :unlet novar
|
|
6616 normally produces the error message >
|
|
6617 E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
6618 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6619 Vim(unlet):E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
6620
|
|
6621 The command >
|
|
6622 :dwim
|
|
6623 normally produces the error message >
|
|
6624 E492: Not an editor command: dwim
|
|
6625 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6626 Vim:E492: Not an editor command: dwim
|
|
6627
|
|
6628 You can catch all ":unlet" errors by a >
|
|
6629 :catch /^Vim(unlet):/
|
|
6630 or all errors for misspelled command names by a >
|
|
6631 :catch /^Vim:E492:/
|
|
6632
|
|
6633 Some error messages may be produced by different commands: >
|
|
6634 :function nofunc
|
|
6635 and >
|
|
6636 :delfunction nofunc
|
|
6637 both produce the error message >
|
|
6638 E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6639 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
|
|
6640 Vim(function):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6641 or >
|
|
6642 Vim(delfunction):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
|
|
6643 respectively. You can catch the error by its number independently on the
|
|
6644 command that caused it if you use the following pattern: >
|
|
6645 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E128:/
|
|
6646
|
|
6647 Some commands like >
|
|
6648 :let x = novar
|
|
6649 produce multiple error messages, here: >
|
|
6650 E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
6651 E15: Invalid expression: novar
|
|
6652 Only the first is used for the exception value, since it is the most specific
|
|
6653 one (see |except-several-errors|). So you can catch it by >
|
|
6654 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E121:/
|
|
6655
|
|
6656 You can catch all errors related to the name "nofunc" by >
|
|
6657 :catch /\<nofunc\>/
|
|
6658
|
|
6659 You can catch all Vim errors in the ":write" and ":read" commands by >
|
|
6660 :catch /^Vim(\(write\|read\)):E\d\+:/
|
|
6661
|
|
6662 You can catch all Vim errors by the pattern >
|
|
6663 :catch /^Vim\((\a\+)\)\=:E\d\+:/
|
|
6664 <
|
|
6665 *catch-text*
|
|
6666 NOTE: You should never catch the error message text itself: >
|
|
6667 :catch /No such variable/
|
|
6668 only works in the english locale, but not when the user has selected
|
|
6669 a different language by the |:language| command. It is however helpful to
|
|
6670 cite the message text in a comment: >
|
|
6671 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E108:/ " No such variable
|
|
6672
|
|
6673
|
|
6674 IGNORING ERRORS *ignore-errors*
|
|
6675
|
|
6676 You can ignore errors in a specific Vim command by catching them locally: >
|
|
6677
|
|
6678 :try
|
|
6679 : write
|
|
6680 :catch
|
|
6681 :endtry
|
|
6682
|
|
6683 But you are strongly recommended NOT to use this simple form, since it could
|
|
6684 catch more than you want. With the ":write" command, some autocommands could
|
|
6685 be executed and cause errors not related to writing, for instance: >
|
|
6686
|
|
6687 :au BufWritePre * unlet novar
|
|
6688
|
|
6689 There could even be such errors you are not responsible for as a script
|
|
6690 writer: a user of your script might have defined such autocommands. You would
|
|
6691 then hide the error from the user.
|
|
6692 It is much better to use >
|
|
6693
|
|
6694 :try
|
|
6695 : write
|
|
6696 :catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
6697 :endtry
|
|
6698
|
|
6699 which only catches real write errors. So catch only what you'd like to ignore
|
|
6700 intentionally.
|
|
6701
|
|
6702 For a single command that does not cause execution of autocommands, you could
|
|
6703 even suppress the conversion of errors to exceptions by the ":silent!"
|
|
6704 command: >
|
|
6705 :silent! nunmap k
|
|
6706 This works also when a try conditional is active.
|
|
6707
|
|
6708
|
|
6709 CATCHING INTERRUPTS *catch-interrupt*
|
|
6710
|
|
6711 When there are active try conditionals, an interrupt (CTRL-C) is converted to
|
|
6712 the exception "Vim:Interrupt". You can catch it like every exception. The
|
|
6713 script is not terminated, then.
|
|
6714 Example: >
|
|
6715
|
|
6716 :function! TASK1()
|
|
6717 : sleep 10
|
|
6718 :endfunction
|
|
6719
|
|
6720 :function! TASK2()
|
|
6721 : sleep 20
|
|
6722 :endfunction
|
|
6723
|
|
6724 :while 1
|
|
6725 : let command = input("Type a command: ")
|
|
6726 : try
|
|
6727 : if command == ""
|
|
6728 : continue
|
|
6729 : elseif command == "END"
|
|
6730 : break
|
|
6731 : elseif command == "TASK1"
|
|
6732 : call TASK1()
|
|
6733 : elseif command == "TASK2"
|
|
6734 : call TASK2()
|
|
6735 : else
|
|
6736 : echo "\nIllegal command:" command
|
|
6737 : continue
|
|
6738 : endif
|
|
6739 : catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
|
|
6740 : echo "\nCommand interrupted"
|
|
6741 : " Caught the interrupt. Continue with next prompt.
|
|
6742 : endtry
|
|
6743 :endwhile
|
|
6744
|
|
6745 You can interrupt a task here by pressing CTRL-C; the script then asks for
|
|
6746 a new command. If you press CTRL-C at the prompt, the script is terminated.
|
|
6747
|
|
6748 For testing what happens when CTRL-C would be pressed on a specific line in
|
|
6749 your script, use the debug mode and execute the |>quit| or |>interrupt|
|
|
6750 command on that line. See |debug-scripts|.
|
|
6751
|
|
6752
|
|
6753 CATCHING ALL *catch-all*
|
|
6754
|
|
6755 The commands >
|
|
6756
|
|
6757 :catch /.*/
|
|
6758 :catch //
|
|
6759 :catch
|
|
6760
|
|
6761 catch everything, error exceptions, interrupt exceptions and exceptions
|
|
6762 explicitly thrown by the |:throw| command. This is useful at the top level of
|
|
6763 a script in order to catch unexpected things.
|
|
6764 Example: >
|
|
6765
|
|
6766 :try
|
|
6767 :
|
|
6768 : " do the hard work here
|
|
6769 :
|
|
6770 :catch /MyException/
|
|
6771 :
|
|
6772 : " handle known problem
|
|
6773 :
|
|
6774 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
|
|
6775 : echo "Script interrupted"
|
|
6776 :catch /.*/
|
|
6777 : echo "Internal error (" . v:exception . ")"
|
|
6778 : echo " - occurred at " . v:throwpoint
|
|
6779 :endtry
|
|
6780 :" end of script
|
|
6781
|
|
6782 Note: Catching all might catch more things than you want. Thus, you are
|
|
6783 strongly encouraged to catch only for problems that you can really handle by
|
|
6784 specifying a pattern argument to the ":catch".
|
|
6785 Example: Catching all could make it nearly impossible to interrupt a script
|
|
6786 by pressing CTRL-C: >
|
|
6787
|
|
6788 :while 1
|
|
6789 : try
|
|
6790 : sleep 1
|
|
6791 : catch
|
|
6792 : endtry
|
|
6793 :endwhile
|
|
6794
|
|
6795
|
|
6796 EXCEPTIONS AND AUTOCOMMANDS *except-autocmd*
|
|
6797
|
|
6798 Exceptions may be used during execution of autocommands. Example: >
|
|
6799
|
|
6800 :autocmd User x try
|
|
6801 :autocmd User x throw "Oops!"
|
|
6802 :autocmd User x catch
|
|
6803 :autocmd User x echo v:exception
|
|
6804 :autocmd User x endtry
|
|
6805 :autocmd User x throw "Arrgh!"
|
|
6806 :autocmd User x echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6807 :
|
|
6808 :try
|
|
6809 : doautocmd User x
|
|
6810 :catch
|
|
6811 : echo v:exception
|
|
6812 :endtry
|
|
6813
|
|
6814 This displays "Oops!" and "Arrgh!".
|
|
6815
|
|
6816 *except-autocmd-Pre*
|
|
6817 For some commands, autocommands get executed before the main action of the
|
|
6818 command takes place. If an exception is thrown and not caught in the sequence
|
|
6819 of autocommands, the sequence and the command that caused its execution are
|
|
6820 abandoned and the exception is propagated to the caller of the command.
|
|
6821 Example: >
|
|
6822
|
|
6823 :autocmd BufWritePre * throw "FAIL"
|
|
6824 :autocmd BufWritePre * echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6825 :
|
|
6826 :try
|
|
6827 : write
|
|
6828 :catch
|
|
6829 : echo "Caught:" v:exception "from" v:throwpoint
|
|
6830 :endtry
|
|
6831
|
|
6832 Here, the ":write" command does not write the file currently being edited (as
|
|
6833 you can see by checking 'modified'), since the exception from the BufWritePre
|
|
6834 autocommand abandons the ":write". The exception is then caught and the
|
|
6835 script displays: >
|
|
6836
|
|
6837 Caught: FAIL from BufWrite Auto commands for "*"
|
|
6838 <
|
|
6839 *except-autocmd-Post*
|
|
6840 For some commands, autocommands get executed after the main action of the
|
|
6841 command has taken place. If this main action fails and the command is inside
|
|
6842 an active try conditional, the autocommands are skipped and an error exception
|
|
6843 is thrown that can be caught by the caller of the command.
|
|
6844 Example: >
|
|
6845
|
|
6846 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "File successfully written!"
|
|
6847 :
|
|
6848 :try
|
|
6849 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6850 :catch
|
|
6851 : echo v:exception
|
|
6852 :endtry
|
|
6853
|
|
6854 This just displays: >
|
|
6855
|
|
6856 Vim(write):E212: Can't open file for writing (/i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e)
|
|
6857
|
|
6858 If you really need to execute the autocommands even when the main action
|
|
6859 fails, trigger the event from the catch clause.
|
|
6860 Example: >
|
|
6861
|
|
6862 :autocmd BufWritePre * set noreadonly
|
|
6863 :autocmd BufWritePost * set readonly
|
|
6864 :
|
|
6865 :try
|
|
6866 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6867 :catch
|
|
6868 : doautocmd BufWritePost /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6869 :endtry
|
|
6870 <
|
|
6871 You can also use ":silent!": >
|
|
6872
|
|
6873 :let x = "ok"
|
|
6874 :let v:errmsg = ""
|
|
6875 :autocmd BufWritePost * if v:errmsg != ""
|
|
6876 :autocmd BufWritePost * let x = "after fail"
|
|
6877 :autocmd BufWritePost * endif
|
|
6878 :try
|
|
6879 : silent! write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
|
|
6880 :catch
|
|
6881 :endtry
|
|
6882 :echo x
|
|
6883
|
|
6884 This displays "after fail".
|
|
6885
|
|
6886 If the main action of the command does not fail, exceptions from the
|
|
6887 autocommands will be catchable by the caller of the command: >
|
|
6888
|
|
6889 :autocmd BufWritePost * throw ":-("
|
|
6890 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "Should not be displayed"
|
|
6891 :
|
|
6892 :try
|
|
6893 : write
|
|
6894 :catch
|
|
6895 : echo v:exception
|
|
6896 :endtry
|
|
6897 <
|
|
6898 *except-autocmd-Cmd*
|
|
6899 For some commands, the normal action can be replaced by a sequence of
|
|
6900 autocommands. Exceptions from that sequence will be catchable by the caller
|
|
6901 of the command.
|
|
6902 Example: For the ":write" command, the caller cannot know whether the file
|
|
6903 had actually been written when the exception occurred. You need to tell it in
|
|
6904 some way. >
|
|
6905
|
|
6906 :if !exists("cnt")
|
|
6907 : let cnt = 0
|
|
6908 :
|
|
6909 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if &modified
|
|
6910 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * let cnt = cnt + 1
|
|
6911 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 2
|
|
6912 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
|
|
6913 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6914 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * write | set nomodified
|
|
6915 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 0
|
|
6916 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
|
|
6917 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6918 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * echo "File successfully written!"
|
|
6919 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
|
|
6920 :endif
|
|
6921 :
|
|
6922 :try
|
|
6923 : write
|
|
6924 :catch /^BufWriteCmdError$/
|
|
6925 : if &modified
|
|
6926 : echo "Error on writing (file contents not changed)"
|
|
6927 : else
|
|
6928 : echo "Error after writing"
|
|
6929 : endif
|
|
6930 :catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
6931 : echo "Error on writing"
|
|
6932 :endtry
|
|
6933
|
|
6934 When this script is sourced several times after making changes, it displays
|
|
6935 first >
|
|
6936 File successfully written!
|
|
6937 then >
|
|
6938 Error on writing (file contents not changed)
|
|
6939 then >
|
|
6940 Error after writing
|
|
6941 etc.
|
|
6942
|
|
6943 *except-autocmd-ill*
|
|
6944 You cannot spread a try conditional over autocommands for different events.
|
|
6945 The following code is ill-formed: >
|
|
6946
|
|
6947 :autocmd BufWritePre * try
|
|
6948 :
|
|
6949 :autocmd BufWritePost * catch
|
|
6950 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo v:exception
|
|
6951 :autocmd BufWritePost * endtry
|
|
6952 :
|
|
6953 :write
|
|
6954
|
|
6955
|
|
6956 EXCEPTION HIERARCHIES AND PARAMETERIZED EXCEPTIONS *except-hier-param*
|
|
6957
|
|
6958 Some programming languages allow to use hierarchies of exception classes or to
|
|
6959 pass additional information with the object of an exception class. You can do
|
|
6960 similar things in Vim.
|
|
6961 In order to throw an exception from a hierarchy, just throw the complete
|
|
6962 class name with the components separated by a colon, for instance throw the
|
|
6963 string "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW" for an overflow in a mathematical library.
|
|
6964 When you want to pass additional information with your exception class, add
|
|
6965 it in parentheses, for instance throw the string "EXCEPT:IO:WRITEERR(myfile)"
|
|
6966 for an error when writing "myfile".
|
|
6967 With the appropriate patterns in the ":catch" command, you can catch for
|
|
6968 base classes or derived classes of your hierarchy. Additional information in
|
|
6969 parentheses can be cut out from |v:exception| with the ":substitute" command.
|
|
6970 Example: >
|
|
6971
|
|
6972 :function! CheckRange(a, func)
|
|
6973 : if a:a < 0
|
|
6974 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE(" . a:func . ")"
|
|
6975 : endif
|
|
6976 :endfunction
|
|
6977 :
|
|
6978 :function! Add(a, b)
|
|
6979 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Add")
|
|
6980 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Add")
|
|
6981 : let c = a:a + a:b
|
|
6982 : if c < 0
|
|
6983 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW"
|
|
6984 : endif
|
|
6985 : return c
|
|
6986 :endfunction
|
|
6987 :
|
|
6988 :function! Div(a, b)
|
|
6989 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Div")
|
|
6990 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Div")
|
|
6991 : if (a:b == 0)
|
|
6992 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:ZERODIV"
|
|
6993 : endif
|
|
6994 : return a:a / a:b
|
|
6995 :endfunction
|
|
6996 :
|
|
6997 :function! Write(file)
|
|
6998 : try
|
|
6999 : execute "write" a:file
|
|
7000 : catch /^Vim(write):/
|
|
7001 : throw "EXCEPT:IO(" . getcwd() . ", " . a:file . "):WRITEERR"
|
|
7002 : endtry
|
|
7003 :endfunction
|
|
7004 :
|
|
7005 :try
|
|
7006 :
|
|
7007 : " something with arithmetics and I/O
|
|
7008 :
|
|
7009 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE/
|
|
7010 : let function = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(\a\+\)).*', '\1', "")
|
|
7011 : echo "Range error in" function
|
|
7012 :
|
|
7013 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR/ " catches OVERFLOW and ZERODIV
|
|
7014 : echo "Math error"
|
|
7015 :
|
|
7016 :catch /^EXCEPT:IO/
|
|
7017 : let dir = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(.\+\),\s*.\+).*', '\1', "")
|
|
7018 : let file = substitute(v:exception, '.*(.\+,\s*\(.\+\)).*', '\1', "")
|
|
7019 : if file !~ '^/'
|
|
7020 : let file = dir . "/" . file
|
|
7021 : endif
|
|
7022 : echo 'I/O error for "' . file . '"'
|
|
7023 :
|
|
7024 :catch /^EXCEPT/
|
|
7025 : echo "Unspecified error"
|
|
7026 :
|
|
7027 :endtry
|
|
7028
|
|
7029 The exceptions raised by Vim itself (on error or when pressing CTRL-C) use
|
|
7030 a flat hierarchy: they are all in the "Vim" class. You cannot throw yourself
|
|
7031 exceptions with the "Vim" prefix; they are reserved for Vim.
|
|
7032 Vim error exceptions are parameterized with the name of the command that
|
|
7033 failed, if known. See |catch-errors|.
|
|
7034
|
|
7035
|
|
7036 PECULIARITIES
|
|
7037 *except-compat*
|
|
7038 The exception handling concept requires that the command sequence causing the
|
|
7039 exception is aborted immediately and control is transferred to finally clauses
|
|
7040 and/or a catch clause.
|
|
7041
|
|
7042 In the Vim script language there are cases where scripts and functions
|
|
7043 continue after an error: in functions without the "abort" flag or in a command
|
|
7044 after ":silent!", control flow goes to the following line, and outside
|
|
7045 functions, control flow goes to the line following the outermost ":endwhile"
|
|
7046 or ":endif". On the other hand, errors should be catchable as exceptions
|
|
7047 (thus, requiring the immediate abortion).
|
|
7048
|
|
7049 This problem has been solved by converting errors to exceptions and using
|
|
7050 immediate abortion (if not suppressed by ":silent!") only when a try
|
|
7051 conditional is active. This is no restriction since an (error) exception can
|
|
7052 be caught only from an active try conditional. If you want an immediate
|
|
7053 termination without catching the error, just use a try conditional without
|
|
7054 catch clause. (You can cause cleanup code being executed before termination
|
|
7055 by specifying a finally clause.)
|
|
7056
|
|
7057 When no try conditional is active, the usual abortion and continuation
|
|
7058 behavior is used instead of immediate abortion. This ensures compatibility of
|
|
7059 scripts written for Vim 6.1 and earlier.
|
|
7060
|
|
7061 However, when sourcing an existing script that does not use exception handling
|
|
7062 commands (or when calling one of its functions) from inside an active try
|
|
7063 conditional of a new script, you might change the control flow of the existing
|
|
7064 script on error. You get the immediate abortion on error and can catch the
|
|
7065 error in the new script. If however the sourced script suppresses error
|
|
7066 messages by using the ":silent!" command (checking for errors by testing
|
|
7067 |v:errmsg| if appropriate), its execution path is not changed. The error is
|
|
7068 not converted to an exception. (See |:silent|.) So the only remaining cause
|
|
7069 where this happens is for scripts that don't care about errors and produce
|
|
7070 error messages. You probably won't want to use such code from your new
|
|
7071 scripts.
|
|
7072
|
|
7073 *except-syntax-err*
|
|
7074 Syntax errors in the exception handling commands are never caught by any of
|
|
7075 the ":catch" commands of the try conditional they belong to. Its finally
|
|
7076 clauses, however, is executed.
|
|
7077 Example: >
|
|
7078
|
|
7079 :try
|
|
7080 : try
|
|
7081 : throw 4711
|
|
7082 : catch /\(/
|
|
7083 : echo "in catch with syntax error"
|
|
7084 : catch
|
|
7085 : echo "inner catch-all"
|
|
7086 : finally
|
|
7087 : echo "inner finally"
|
|
7088 : endtry
|
|
7089 :catch
|
|
7090 : echo 'outer catch-all caught "' . v:exception . '"'
|
|
7091 : finally
|
|
7092 : echo "outer finally"
|
|
7093 :endtry
|
|
7094
|
|
7095 This displays: >
|
|
7096 inner finally
|
|
7097 outer catch-all caught "Vim(catch):E54: Unmatched \("
|
|
7098 outer finally
|
|
7099 The original exception is discarded and an error exception is raised, instead.
|
|
7100
|
|
7101 *except-single-line*
|
|
7102 The ":try", ":catch", ":finally", and ":endtry" commands can be put on
|
|
7103 a single line, but then syntax errors may make it difficult to recognize the
|
|
7104 "catch" line, thus you better avoid this.
|
|
7105 Example: >
|
|
7106 :try | unlet! foo # | catch | endtry
|
|
7107 raises an error exception for the trailing characters after the ":unlet!"
|
|
7108 argument, but does not see the ":catch" and ":endtry" commands, so that the
|
|
7109 error exception is discarded and the "E488: Trailing characters" message gets
|
|
7110 displayed.
|
|
7111
|
|
7112 *except-several-errors*
|
|
7113 When several errors appear in a single command, the first error message is
|
|
7114 usually the most specific one and therefor converted to the error exception.
|
|
7115 Example: >
|
|
7116 echo novar
|
|
7117 causes >
|
|
7118 E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
7119 E15: Invalid expression: novar
|
|
7120 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
|
|
7121 Vim(echo):E121: Undefined variable: novar
|
|
7122 < *except-syntax-error*
|
|
7123 But when a syntax error is detected after a normal error in the same command,
|
|
7124 the syntax error is used for the exception being thrown.
|
|
7125 Example: >
|
|
7126 unlet novar #
|
|
7127 causes >
|
|
7128 E108: No such variable: "novar"
|
|
7129 E488: Trailing characters
|
|
7130 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
|
|
7131 Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters
|
|
7132 This is done because the syntax error might change the execution path in a way
|
|
7133 not intended by the user. Example: >
|
|
7134 try
|
|
7135 try | unlet novar # | catch | echo v:exception | endtry
|
|
7136 catch /.*/
|
|
7137 echo "outer catch:" v:exception
|
|
7138 endtry
|
|
7139 This displays "outer catch: Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters", and then
|
|
7140 a "E600: Missing :endtry" error message is given, see |except-single-line|.
|
|
7141
|
|
7142 ==============================================================================
|
|
7143 9. Examples *eval-examples*
|
|
7144
|
|
7145 Printing in Hex ~
|
|
7146 >
|
|
7147 :" The function Nr2Hex() returns the Hex string of a number.
|
|
7148 :func Nr2Hex(nr)
|
|
7149 : let n = a:nr
|
|
7150 : let r = ""
|
|
7151 : while n
|
|
7152 : let r = '0123456789ABCDEF'[n % 16] . r
|
|
7153 : let n = n / 16
|
|
7154 : endwhile
|
|
7155 : return r
|
|
7156 :endfunc
|
|
7157
|
|
7158 :" The function String2Hex() converts each character in a string to a two
|
|
7159 :" character Hex string.
|
|
7160 :func String2Hex(str)
|
|
7161 : let out = ''
|
|
7162 : let ix = 0
|
|
7163 : while ix < strlen(a:str)
|
|
7164 : let out = out . Nr2Hex(char2nr(a:str[ix]))
|
|
7165 : let ix = ix + 1
|
|
7166 : endwhile
|
|
7167 : return out
|
|
7168 :endfunc
|
|
7169
|
|
7170 Example of its use: >
|
|
7171 :echo Nr2Hex(32)
|
|
7172 result: "20" >
|
|
7173 :echo String2Hex("32")
|
|
7174 result: "3332"
|
|
7175
|
|
7176
|
|
7177 Sorting lines (by Robert Webb) ~
|
|
7178
|
|
7179 Here is a Vim script to sort lines. Highlight the lines in Vim and type
|
|
7180 ":Sort". This doesn't call any external programs so it'll work on any
|
|
7181 platform. The function Sort() actually takes the name of a comparison
|
|
7182 function as its argument, like qsort() does in C. So you could supply it
|
|
7183 with different comparison functions in order to sort according to date etc.
|
|
7184 >
|
|
7185 :" Function for use with Sort(), to compare two strings.
|
|
7186 :func! Strcmp(str1, str2)
|
|
7187 : if (a:str1 < a:str2)
|
|
7188 : return -1
|
|
7189 : elseif (a:str1 > a:str2)
|
|
7190 : return 1
|
|
7191 : else
|
|
7192 : return 0
|
|
7193 : endif
|
|
7194 :endfunction
|
|
7195
|
|
7196 :" Sort lines. SortR() is called recursively.
|
|
7197 :func! SortR(start, end, cmp)
|
|
7198 : if (a:start >= a:end)
|
|
7199 : return
|
|
7200 : endif
|
|
7201 : let partition = a:start - 1
|
|
7202 : let middle = partition
|
|
7203 : let partStr = getline((a:start + a:end) / 2)
|
|
7204 : let i = a:start
|
|
7205 : while (i <= a:end)
|
|
7206 : let str = getline(i)
|
|
7207 : exec "let result = " . a:cmp . "(str, partStr)"
|
|
7208 : if (result <= 0)
|
|
7209 : " Need to put it before the partition. Swap lines i and partition.
|
|
7210 : let partition = partition + 1
|
|
7211 : if (result == 0)
|
|
7212 : let middle = partition
|
|
7213 : endif
|
|
7214 : if (i != partition)
|
|
7215 : let str2 = getline(partition)
|
|
7216 : call setline(i, str2)
|
|
7217 : call setline(partition, str)
|
|
7218 : endif
|
|
7219 : endif
|
|
7220 : let i = i + 1
|
|
7221 : endwhile
|
|
7222
|
|
7223 : " Now we have a pointer to the "middle" element, as far as partitioning
|
|
7224 : " goes, which could be anywhere before the partition. Make sure it is at
|
|
7225 : " the end of the partition.
|
|
7226 : if (middle != partition)
|
|
7227 : let str = getline(middle)
|
|
7228 : let str2 = getline(partition)
|
|
7229 : call setline(middle, str2)
|
|
7230 : call setline(partition, str)
|
|
7231 : endif
|
|
7232 : call SortR(a:start, partition - 1, a:cmp)
|
|
7233 : call SortR(partition + 1, a:end, a:cmp)
|
|
7234 :endfunc
|
|
7235
|
|
7236 :" To Sort a range of lines, pass the range to Sort() along with the name of a
|
|
7237 :" function that will compare two lines.
|
|
7238 :func! Sort(cmp) range
|
|
7239 : call SortR(a:firstline, a:lastline, a:cmp)
|
|
7240 :endfunc
|
|
7241
|
|
7242 :" :Sort takes a range of lines and sorts them.
|
|
7243 :command! -nargs=0 -range Sort <line1>,<line2>call Sort("Strcmp")
|
|
7244 <
|
|
7245 *sscanf*
|
|
7246 There is no sscanf() function in Vim. If you need to extract parts from a
|
|
7247 line, you can use matchstr() and substitute() to do it. This example shows
|
|
7248 how to get the file name, line number and column number out of a line like
|
|
7249 "foobar.txt, 123, 45". >
|
|
7250 :" Set up the match bit
|
|
7251 :let mx='\(\f\+\),\s*\(\d\+\),\s*\(\d\+\)'
|
|
7252 :"get the part matching the whole expression
|
|
7253 :let l = matchstr(line, mx)
|
|
7254 :"get each item out of the match
|
|
7255 :let file = substitute(l, mx, '\1', '')
|
|
7256 :let lnum = substitute(l, mx, '\2', '')
|
|
7257 :let col = substitute(l, mx, '\3', '')
|
|
7258
|
|
7259 The input is in the variable "line", the results in the variables "file",
|
|
7260 "lnum" and "col". (idea from Michael Geddes)
|
|
7261
|
|
7262 ==============================================================================
|
|
7263 10. No +eval feature *no-eval-feature*
|
|
7264
|
|
7265 When the |+eval| feature was disabled at compile time, none of the expression
|
|
7266 evaluation commands are available. To prevent this from causing Vim scripts
|
|
7267 to generate all kinds of errors, the ":if" and ":endif" commands are still
|
|
7268 recognized, though the argument of the ":if" and everything between the ":if"
|
|
7269 and the matching ":endif" is ignored. Nesting of ":if" blocks is allowed, but
|
|
7270 only if the commands are at the start of the line. The ":else" command is not
|
|
7271 recognized.
|
|
7272
|
|
7273 Example of how to avoid executing commands when the |+eval| feature is
|
|
7274 missing: >
|
|
7275
|
|
7276 :if 1
|
|
7277 : echo "Expression evaluation is compiled in"
|
|
7278 :else
|
|
7279 : echo "You will _never_ see this message"
|
|
7280 :endif
|
|
7281
|
|
7282 ==============================================================================
|
|
7283 11. The sandbox *eval-sandbox* *sandbox* *E48*
|
|
7284
|
|
7285 The 'foldexpr', 'includeexpr', 'indentexpr', 'statusline' and 'foldtext'
|
|
7286 options are evaluated in a sandbox. This means that you are protected from
|
|
7287 these expressions having nasty side effects. This gives some safety for when
|
|
7288 these options are set from a modeline. It is also used when the command from
|
620
|
7289 a tags file is executed and for CTRL-R = in the command line.
|
29
|
7290 The sandbox is also used for the |:sandbox| command.
|
7
|
7291
|
|
7292 These items are not allowed in the sandbox:
|
|
7293 - changing the buffer text
|
|
7294 - defining or changing mapping, autocommands, functions, user commands
|
|
7295 - setting certain options (see |option-summary|)
|
|
7296 - executing a shell command
|
|
7297 - reading or writing a file
|
|
7298 - jumping to another buffer or editing a file
|
625
|
7299 - executing Python, Perl, etc. commands
|
29
|
7300 This is not guaranteed 100% secure, but it should block most attacks.
|
|
7301
|
|
7302 *:san* *:sandbox*
|
401
|
7303 :san[dbox] {cmd} Execute {cmd} in the sandbox. Useful to evaluate an
|
29
|
7304 option that may have been set from a modeline, e.g.
|
|
7305 'foldexpr'.
|
|
7306
|
634
|
7307 *sandbox-option*
|
|
7308 A few options contain an expression. When this expression is evaluated it may
|
790
|
7309 have to be done in the sandbox to avoid a security risk. But the sandbox is
|
634
|
7310 restrictive, thus this only happens when the option was set from an insecure
|
|
7311 location. Insecure in this context are:
|
843
|
7312 - sourcing a .vimrc or .exrc in the current directory
|
634
|
7313 - while executing in the sandbox
|
|
7314 - value coming from a modeline
|
|
7315
|
|
7316 Note that when in the sandbox and saving an option value and restoring it, the
|
|
7317 option will still be marked as it was set in the sandbox.
|
|
7318
|
|
7319 ==============================================================================
|
|
7320 12. Textlock *textlock*
|
|
7321
|
|
7322 In a few situations it is not allowed to change the text in the buffer, jump
|
|
7323 to another window and some other things that might confuse or break what Vim
|
|
7324 is currently doing. This mostly applies to things that happen when Vim is
|
|
7325 actually doing something else. For example, evaluating the 'balloonexpr' may
|
|
7326 happen any moment the mouse cursor is resting at some position.
|
|
7327
|
|
7328 This is not allowed when the textlock is active:
|
|
7329 - changing the buffer text
|
|
7330 - jumping to another buffer or window
|
|
7331 - editing another file
|
|
7332 - closing a window or quitting Vim
|
|
7333 - etc.
|
|
7334
|
7
|
7335
|
|
7336 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
|